US6262302B1 - N-(aryl/heteroaryl/alkylacetyl) amino acid amides, pharmaceutical compositions comprising same, and methods for inhibiting β-amyloid peptide release and/or its synthesis by use of such compounds - Google Patents

N-(aryl/heteroaryl/alkylacetyl) amino acid amides, pharmaceutical compositions comprising same, and methods for inhibiting β-amyloid peptide release and/or its synthesis by use of such compounds Download PDF

Info

Publication number
US6262302B1
US6262302B1 US09/398,211 US39821199A US6262302B1 US 6262302 B1 US6262302 B1 US 6262302B1 US 39821199 A US39821199 A US 39821199A US 6262302 B1 US6262302 B1 US 6262302B1
Authority
US
United States
Prior art keywords
group
alkyl
hydrogen
substituted
heteroaryl
Prior art date
Legal status (The legal status is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the status listed.)
Expired - Fee Related
Application number
US09/398,211
Inventor
Jing Wu
Jay S. Tung
Jeffrey S. Nissen
Thomas E. Mabry
Lee H. Latimer
Clark N. Eid
James E. Audia
Current Assignee (The listed assignees may be inaccurate. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation or warranty as to the accuracy of the list.)
Elan Pharmaceuticals LLC
Eli Lilly and Co
Original Assignee
Elan Pharmaceuticals LLC
Eli Lilly and Co
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Application filed by Elan Pharmaceuticals LLC, Eli Lilly and Co filed Critical Elan Pharmaceuticals LLC
Priority to US09/398,211 priority Critical patent/US6262302B1/en
Application granted granted Critical
Publication of US6262302B1 publication Critical patent/US6262302B1/en
Anticipated expiration legal-status Critical
Expired - Fee Related legal-status Critical Current

Links

Classifications

    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/275Nitriles; Isonitriles
    • A61K31/277Nitriles; Isonitriles having a ring, e.g. verapamil
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/185Acids; Anhydrides, halides or salts thereof, e.g. sulfur acids, imidic, hydrazonic or hydroximic acids
    • A61K31/19Carboxylic acids, e.g. valproic acid
    • A61K31/195Carboxylic acids, e.g. valproic acid having an amino group
    • A61K31/197Carboxylic acids, e.g. valproic acid having an amino group the amino and the carboxyl groups being attached to the same acyclic carbon chain, e.g. gamma-aminobutyric acid [GABA], beta-alanine, epsilon-aminocaproic acid, pantothenic acid
    • A61K31/198Alpha-aminoacids, e.g. alanine, edetic acids [EDTA]
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/21Esters, e.g. nitroglycerine, selenocyanates
    • A61K31/215Esters, e.g. nitroglycerine, selenocyanates of carboxylic acids
    • A61K31/22Esters, e.g. nitroglycerine, selenocyanates of carboxylic acids of acyclic acids, e.g. pravastatin
    • A61K31/223Esters, e.g. nitroglycerine, selenocyanates of carboxylic acids of acyclic acids, e.g. pravastatin of alpha-aminoacids
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/33Heterocyclic compounds
    • A61K31/395Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins
    • A61K31/435Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having six-membered rings with one nitrogen as the only ring hetero atom
    • A61K31/44Non condensed pyridines; Hydrogenated derivatives thereof

Definitions

  • This invention relates to compounds which inhibit cellular ⁇ -amyloid peptide release and/or its synthesis, and, accordingly, have utility in treating Alzheimer's disease.
  • This invention also relates to pharmaceutical compositions comprising such compounds as well as methods for inhibiting release of ⁇ -amyloid peptide.
  • AD Alzheimer's Disease
  • AD is a degenerative brain disorder characterized clinically by progressive loss of memory, cognition, reasoning, judgment and emotional stability that gradually leads to profound mental deterioration and ultimately death.
  • AD is a very common cause of progressive mental failure (dementia) in aged humans and is believed to represent the fourth most common medical cause of death in the United States.
  • AD has been observed in races and ethnic groups worldwide and presents a major present and future public health problem. The disease is currently estimated to affect about two to three million individuals in the United States alone. AD is at present incurable. No treatment that effectively prevents AD or reverses its symptoms and course is currently known.
  • the brains of individuals with AD exhibit characteristic lesions termed senile (or amyloid) plaques, amyloid angiopathy (amyloid deposits in blood vessels) and neurofibrillary tangles.
  • senile or amyloid
  • amyloid angiopathy amyloid deposits in blood vessels
  • neurofibrillary tangles Large numbers of these lesions, particularly amyloid plaques and neurofibrillary tangles, are generally found in several areas of the human brain important for memory and cognitive function in patients with AD. Smaller numbers of these lesions in a more restrictive anatomical distribution are also found in the brains of most aged humans who do not have clinical AD.
  • Amyloid plaques and amyloid angiopathy also characterize the brains of individuals with Trisomy 21 (Down's Syndrome) and Hereditary Cerebral Hemorrhage with Amyloidosis of the Dutch Type (HCHWA-D).
  • a definitive diagnosis of AD usually requires observing the aforementioned lesions in the brain tissue of patients who have died with the disease or, rarely, in small biopsied samples of brain tissue taken during an invasive neurosurgical procedure.
  • amyloid angiopathy amyloid angiopathy characteristic of AD and the other disorders mentioned above is an approximately 4.2 kilodalton (kD) protein of about 39-43 amino acids designated the ⁇ -amyloid peptide ( ⁇ AP) or sometimes A ⁇ , A ⁇ P or ⁇ /A4.
  • ⁇ AP ⁇ -amyloid peptide
  • ⁇ -Amyloid peptide was first purified and a partial amino acid sequence was provided by Glenner, et al. 1 The isolation procedure and the sequence data for the first 28 amino acids are described in U.S. Pat. No. 4,666,829 2 .
  • ⁇ -amyloid peptide is a small fragment of a much larger precursor protein (APP), that is normally produced by cells in many tissues of various animals, including humans.
  • APP precursor protein
  • Knowledge of the structure of the gene encoding the APP has demonstrated that ⁇ -amyloid peptide arises as a peptide fragment that is cleaved from APP by protease enzyme(s).
  • protease enzyme(s) The precise biochemical mechanism by which the ⁇ -amyloid peptide fragment is cleaved from APP and subsequently deposited as amyloid plaques in the cerebral tissue and in the walls of the cerebral and meningeal blood vessels is currently unknown.
  • a mutation at amino acid 693 of the 770-amino acid isoform of APP has been identified as the cause of the ⁇ -amyloid peptide deposition disease, HCHWA-D, and a change from alanine to glycine at amino acid 692 appears to cause a phenotype that resembles AD is some patients but HCHWA-D in others.
  • the discovery of these and other mutations in APP in genetically based cases of AD prove that alteration of APP and subsequent deposition of its ⁇ -amyloid peptide fragment can cause AD.
  • the treatment methods would advantageously be based on drugs which are capable of inhibiting ⁇ -amyloid peptide release and/or its synthesis in vivo.
  • This invention is directed to the discovery of a class of compounds which inhibit ⁇ -amyloid peptide release and/or its synthesis and, therefore, are useful in the prevention of AD in patients susceptible to AD and/or in the treatment of patients with AD in order to inhibit further deterioration in their condition.
  • the class of compounds having the described properties are defined by formula I below:
  • R 1 is selected from the group consisting of
  • R is alkylene of from 1 to 8 carbon atoms
  • n is an integer equal to 0 or 1
  • R a and R a′ are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, hydroxy, fluoro and methyl;
  • R b and R b′ are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkoxy, aryl, aryloxy, cyano, cycloalkyl, halo, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heterocyclic, nitro, trihalomethyl, thioalkoxy, thioaryloxy, thioheteroaryloxy, and —C(O)R 4 where R 4 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, aryl, alkoxy and aryloxy; and
  • R c is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, aryl, cyano, halo, nitro, and where R b and R c are fused to form a methylenedioxy ring with the phenyl ring;
  • R b and/or R b′ and/or R c when R b and/or R b′ and/or R c is fluoro, chloro, bromo and/or nitro, then R a and/or R a′ can also be chloro;
  • R 2 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl of from 1 to 4 carbon atoms, alkylalkoxy of from 1 to 4 carbon atoms, alkylthioalkoxy of from 1 to 4 carbon atoms;
  • R 3 and R 3′ are independently selected from the group consisting of:
  • R 5 , R 5′ , R 9 and R 9′ are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, hydroxyl, alkyl, substituted alkyl, alkoxy, substituted alkoxy, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, aryl, acyl, acylamino, acyloxy, aminoacyl, cyano, cycloalkyl, halogen, carboxyl, carboxyl esters, heteroaryl and heterocyclic; and
  • R 6 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, hydroxyl, alkyl, substituted alkyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, aryl, acyl, acylamino, acyloxy, alkoxy, substituted alkoxy, aminoacyl, cyano, cycloalkyl, halogen, carboxyl, carboxyl esters, heteroaryl, heterocyclic and where R 6 and one of R 5 or R 5′ are fused to from a heterocyclic ring of from 4 to 10 atoms having from 1 to 3 heteroatoms selected from the group consisting of oxygen, nitrogen and sulfur;
  • R 9 and R 9′ are hydrogen
  • n is an integer equal to 0 or 1
  • p 2 p is an integer equal to 1 to 3 with the proviso that when n is zero then p is equal to 1
  • X′ is hydrogen, hydroxy or fluoro
  • X′′ is hydrogen, hydroxy or fluoro, or X′ and X′′ together form an oxo group
  • Z is selected from the group consisting of a bond covalently linking R 1 to —CX′X′′—, oxygen and sulfur;
  • R 1 is phenyl
  • R 2 is methyl
  • X′ and X′′ are hydrogen
  • Z is a group covalently linking R 1 to —CX′X′′—
  • m is zero
  • R 3 is hydrogen
  • R 3′ is —(R 7 ) n (W) p where n is zero and p is one and W is
  • R 5 , R 5′ , R 9 , R 9′ and R 6 are not all hydrogen and (ii) R 5 , R 5′ , R 9 , R 9′ are hydrogen and R 6 is methoxy;
  • R 1 is 3,5-difluorophenyl
  • R 2 is methyl
  • X′ and X′′ are hydrogen
  • Z is a group covalently lining R 1 to —CX′X′′—
  • m is zero
  • R 3 is hydrogen
  • R 3′ is —(R 7 ) n (W) p where n is one and p is one, R 7 is ethylene and W is
  • R 5 , R 5′ , R 9 , R 9′ and R 6 are not all hydrogen
  • R 1 is 3,5-difluorophenyl
  • R 2 is methyl
  • X′ and X′′ are hydrogen
  • Z is a group covalently linking R 1 to —CX′X′′—
  • m is zero
  • R 3 is hydrogen
  • R 3′ is —(R 7 ) n (W) p where n is zero and p is one
  • W is
  • R 5′ , R 9 , R 9′ are hydrogen, then R 5 and R 6 are not fused to form, with the phenyl ring to which they are attached, a phthalimido group.
  • this invention is directed to a method for inhibiting ⁇ -amyloid peptide release and/or its synthesis in a cell which method comprises administering to such a cell an amount of a compound or a mixture of compounds of formula I above effective in inhibiting the cellular release and/or synthesis of ⁇ -amyloid peptide.
  • this invention is directed to a prophylactic method for preventing the onset of AD in a patient at risk for developing AD which method comprises administering to said patient a pharmaceutical composition comprising a pharmaceutically inert carrier and an effective amount of a compound or a mixture of compounds of formula I above.
  • this invention is directed to a therapeutic method for treating a patient with AD in order to inhibit further deterioration in the condition of that patient which method comprises administering to said patient a pharmaceutical composition comprising a pharmaceutically inert carrier and an effective amount of a compound or a mixture of compounds of formula I above.
  • preferred R 1 unsubstituted aryl groups include, for example, phenyl, 1-naphthyl, 2-naphthyl, and the like.
  • R 1 substituted aryl groups include, for example, monosubstituted phenyls having a single substitution at the 2, 3 or 4 positions where each of the particular subsituents is governed by the respective R a , R b and R c groups; disubstituted phenyls which include those having two substituents at the 2,3-positions, 2,4-positions, 2,5-positions, 2,6-positions, 3,4-positions, 3,5-positions or 3,6-positions where each of these substituents is governed by the respective R a , R a′ , R b , R b′ and R c groups; and trisubstituted phenyls which include those having three substituents at the 2,3,4-positions, 2,3,5-positions, 2,3,6-positions, 3,4,5-positions and 3,4,6-positions again where each of these substituents is governed by the respective R a , R a′ , R b , R
  • substituted phenyls include, for instance, 4-fluorophenyl, 4-chlorophenyl, 4-bromophenyl, 4-nitrophenyl, 4-methylphenyl, 3-methoxy-phenyl, 3-nitrophenyl, 3-fluorophenyl, 3-chlorophenyl, 3-bromophenyl, 3-thiomethoxyphenyl, 3-methylphenyl, 3-trifluoromethylphenyl, 2-hydroxy-phenyl, 2-methylphenyl, 2-fluorophenyl, 3,4-dichlorophenyl, 3,4-methylene-dioxyphenyl, 3,5-difluorophenyl, 3,5-dichlorophenyl, 2,4-dichlorophenyl, and 2,5-difluorophenyl.
  • R 1 alkaryl groups include, by way of example, benzyl, 3-phenylethyl, 4-phenyl-n-propyl, and the like.
  • R 1 alkyl, cycloalkyl and cycloalkenyl groups include, by way of example, sec-butyl, cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclohexyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohex-1-enyl, —CH 2 -cyclopropyl, —CH 2 -cyclobutyl, —CH 2 -cyclohexyl, —CH 2 -cyclopentyl, —CH 2 CH 2 -cyclopropyl, —CH 2 CH 2 -cyclobutyl, —CH 2 CH 2 -cyclohexyl, —CH 2 CH 2 -cyclopentyl, and the like.
  • R 1 heteroaryls and substituted heteroaryls include, by way of example, pyrid-3-yl, pyrid-4-yl, thiophen-2-yl, thiophen-3-yl, benzothiazol4-yl, 2-phenylbenzoxazol-5-yl, furan-2-yl, benzofuran-2-yl, thionaphthen-2-yl, 2-chlorothiophen-5-yl, 3-methylisoxazol-5-yl, 2-(thiophenyl)thiophen-5-yl, 6-methoxythionaphthen-2-yl, 3-phenyl-1,2,4-thiooxadiazol-5-yl, 2-phenyloxazol-4-yl, and the like.
  • R 2 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl of from 1 to 4 carbon atoms, alkylalkoxy of from 1 to 4 carbon atoms and alkylthioalkoxy of from 1 to 4 carbon atoms.
  • Particularly preferred R 2 substituents include, by way of example, methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, iso-propyl, n-butyl, iso-butyl, —CH 2 CH 2 SCH 3 , and the like.
  • R 3 is hydrogen and R 3′ is selected from the group consisting of 3-hydroxyphenyl, 3-methoxyphenyl, 3-ethoxycarbonylphenyl, n-hexyl, n-octyl, 4-ethoxycarbonylphenyl, 4-methoxycarbonylphenyl, 3chlorophenyl, 3-cyanophenyl, 3,5-dichlorophenyl, —CH(CH 3 ) ⁇ (R stereoisomer), —CH(CH 3 ) ⁇ (S stereoisomer), phthalid-6-yl, 2-hydroxypyrid-3-yl, 2-(methoxycarbonylmethyl)benzyl, 3-(methoxycarbonyl)benzyl, 2-(2′-methoxycarbonylmethylphenyl)benzyl, and 2-phenylbenzyl.
  • Particularly preferred compounds for use in the methods and compositions of this invention include, by way of example, the following:
  • R 1 R 2 R 3′ - ⁇ —CH 3 3-HO- ⁇ - - ⁇ —CH 3 3-CH 3 O- ⁇ - - ⁇ —CH 3 3-CH 3 CH 2 O(CO)- ⁇ - - ⁇ —CH 3 4-CH 3 CH 2 O(O)C- ⁇ - 3,5-di-F- ⁇ - —CH 3 CH 3 (CH 2 ) 5- 3,5-di-F- ⁇ - —CH 3 CH 3 (CH 2 ) 7 - 3,5-di-F- ⁇ - —CH 3 3-CH 3 O- ⁇ - 3,5-di-F- ⁇ - —CH 3 4-CH 3 CH 2 O(O)C- ⁇ - 3,5-di-F- ⁇ - —CH 3 3-CH ⁇ CH 2 O(O)C- ⁇ - 3,5-di-F- ⁇ - —CH 3 3-Cl- ⁇ - 3,5-di-F- ⁇ - —CH 3 3,5-di-Cl- ⁇ - 3,5-di-F- ⁇ - —CH 3 3-cyano- ⁇ - 3,5-di-
  • this invention relates to compounds which inhibit ⁇ -amyloid peptide release and/or its synthesis, and, accordingly, have utility in treating Alzheimer's disease.
  • ⁇ -amyloid peptide release and/or its synthesis relates to compounds which inhibit ⁇ -amyloid peptide release and/or its synthesis, and, accordingly, have utility in treating Alzheimer's disease.
  • ⁇ -amyloid peptide refers to a 39-43 amino acid peptide having a molecular weight of about 4.2 kD, which peptide is substantially homologous to the form of the protein described by Glenner, et al. 1 including mutations and post-translational modifications of the normal ⁇ -amyloid peptide.
  • the ⁇ -amyloid peptide is an approximately 39-43 amino acid fragment of a large membrane-spanning glycoprotein, referred to as the ⁇ -amyloid precursor protein (APP). Its 43-amino acid sequence is:
  • Alkyl refers to monovalent alkyl groups preferably having from 1 to 20 carbon atoms, preferably 1 to 10 carbon atoms, and more preferably 1 to 6 carbon atoms. This term is exemplified by groups such as methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, iso-propyl, n-butyl, iso-butyl, n-hexyl, and the like.
  • Substituted alkyl refers to an alkyl group, preferably of from 1 to 10 carbon atoms, having from 1 to 3 substituents selected from the group consisting of alkoxy, substituted alkoxy, acyl, acyloxy, acylamino, amino, aminoacyl, aminocarboxy esters, cyano, cycloalkyl, halogen, hydroxyl, carboxyl, carboxyl esters, thiol, thioalkoxy, substituted thioalkoxy, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclic, nitro, and mono- and di-alkylamino, mono- and di-(substituted alkyl)amino, mono- and di-arylamino, mono- and di-heteroarylamino, mono- and di-heterocyclic amino, and unsymmetric di-substituted amines having different substituents selected from alkyl, substituted alkyl, aryl, heteroaryl and heterocyclic
  • Alkylene refers to divalent alkylene groups preferably having from 1 to 10 carbon atoms and more preferably 1 to 6-carbon atoms which can be straight chain or branched. This term is exemplified by groups such as methylene (—CH 2 —), ethylene (—CH 2 CH 2 —), the propylene isomers (e.g., —CH 2 CH 2 CH 2 — and —CH(CH 3 )CH 2 —) and the like.
  • Alkaryl refers to -alkylene-aryl groups preferably having from 1 to 10 carbon atoms in the alkylene moiety and from 6 to 14 carbon atoms in the aryl moiety. Such alkaryl groups are exemplified by benzyl, phenethyl, and the like.
  • Alkcycloalkyl refers to -alkylene-cycloalkyl groups preferably having from 1 to 10 carbon atoms in the alkylene moiety and from 3 to 8 carbon atoms in the cycloalkyl moiety. Such alkcycloalkyl groups are exemplified by —CH 2 -cyclopropyl, —CH 2 CH 2 -cyclohexyl, and the like.
  • Alkoxy refers to the group “alkyl-O—”. Preferred alkoxy groups include, by way of example, methoxy, ethoxy, n-propoxy, iso-propoxy, n-butoxy, tert-butoxy, sec-butoxy, n-pentoxy, n-hexoxy, 1,2-dimethylbutoxy, and the like.
  • Substituted alkoxy refers to the group “substituted alkyl-O—” where substituted alkyl is as defined above.
  • Alkylalkoxy refers to the group “-alkylene-O-alkyl” which includes by way of example, methylenemethoxy (—CH 2 OCH 3 ), ethylenemethoxy (—CH 2 CH 2 OCH 3 ), methylene-iso-propoxy (—CH 2 O—CH(CH 3 ) 2 ) and the like.
  • Alkylthioalkoxy refers to the group “-alkylene-S-alkyl” which includes by way of example, methylenethiomethoxy (—CH 2 SCH 3 ), ethylenethiomethoxy (—CH 2 CH 2 SCH 3 ), methylene-iso-thiopropoxy (—CH 2 SCH(CH 3 ) 2 ) and the like.
  • Alkenyl refers to alkenyl groups preferably having from 2 to 10 carbon atoms and more preferably 2 to 6 carbon atoms and having at least 1 and preferably from 1-2 sites of alkenyl unsaturation.
  • Preferred alkenyl groups include ethenyl (—CH ⁇ CH 2 ), n-propenyl (—CH 2 CH ⁇ CH 2 ), iso-propenyl (—C(CH 3 ) ⁇ CH 2 ), and the like.
  • Alkynyl refers to alkynyl groups preferably having from 2 to 10 carbon atoms and more preferably 2 to 6 carbon atoms and having at least 1 and preferably from 1-2 sites of alkynyl unsaturation.
  • Preferred alkynyl groups include ethynyl (—CH ⁇ CH 2 ), propargyl (—CH 2 CH ⁇ CH 2 ), and the like.
  • “Acyl” refers to the groups alkyl-C(O)—, substituted alkyl-C(O)—, cycloalkyl-C(O)—, aryl-C(O)—, heteroaryl-C(O)—, and heterocyclic-C(O)— where alkyl, substituted alkyl, cycloalkyl, aryl and heteroaryl are as defined herein.
  • “Acylamino” refers to the group —C(O)NRR where each R is independently hydrogen or alkyl.
  • aminoacyl refers to the group —NRC(O)R where each R is independently hydrogen or alkyl.
  • Alkyloxy refers to the groups alkyl-C(O)O—, substituted alkyl-C(O)O—, cycloalkyl-C(O)O—, aryl-C(O)O—, heteroaryl-C(O)O—, and heterocyclic-C(O)O— where alkyl, substituted alkyl, cycloalkyl, aryl, heteroaryl and heterocyclic are as defined herein.
  • Aryl refers to an unsaturated aromatic carbocyclic group of from 6 to 14 carbon atoms having a single ring (e.g., phenyl) or multiple condensed rings (e.g., naphthyl or anthryl). Preferred aryls include phenyl, naphthyl and the like.
  • such aryl groups can optionally be substituted with from 1 to 3 substituents selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, acyl, acyloxy, alkyl, alkoxy, alkenyl, alkynyl, amino, aminoacyl, aryl, aryloxy, carboxyl, carboxyl esters, amino carboxyl esters, cyano, halo, nitro, heteroaryl, heterocyclic, thioalkoxy, trihalomethyl and the like.
  • substituents include alkyl, alkoxy, halo, cyano, nitro, trihalomethyl, and thioalkoxy.
  • Aryloxy refers to the group aryl-O— wherein the aryl group is as defined above including optionally substituted aryl groups as also defined above.
  • Carboxyl refers to the group —C(O)OH
  • Carboxyl esters refer to the groups —C(O)O-alkyl, —C(O)O-substituted alkyl, —C(O)O-aryl, —C(O)O-heteroaryl, and —C(O)O-heterocyclic
  • aminocarboxyl esters refer to the groups —NHC(O)OR where R is alkyl, substituted alkyl, aryl, cycloalkyl, heteroaryl, or heterocyclic.
  • Cycloalkyl refers to cyclic alkyl groups of from 3 to 10 carbon atoms having a single cyclic ring or multiple condensed rings which can be optionally substituted with from 1 to 3 alkyl groups.
  • Such cycloalkyl groups include, by way of example, single ring structures such as cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclooctyl, 1-methylcyclopropyl, 2-methylcyclopentyl, 2-methylcyclooctyl, and the like, or multiple ring structures such as adamantanyl, and the like.
  • Cycloalkenyl refers to cyclic alkenyl groups of from 4 to 10 carbon atoms having a single cyclic ring and at least one point of internal unsaturation which can be optionally substituted with from 1 to 3 alkyl groups.
  • suitable cycloalkenyl groups include, for instance, cyclobut-2-enyl, cyclopent-3-enyl, cyclooct-3-enyl and the like.
  • Halo or “halogen” refers to fluoro, chloro, bromo and iodo and preferably is either fluoro or chloro.
  • Heteroaryl refers to a monovalent aromatic carbocyclic group of from 1 to 10 carbon atoms and 1 to 4 heteroatoms selected from oxygen, nitrogen and sulfur within the ring.
  • heteroaryl groups can be optionally substituted with 1 to 3 substituents selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, aryl, aryloxy, halo, nitro, heteroaryl, hydroxy, thioalkoxy, thioaryloxy and the like.
  • Such heteroaryl groups can have a single ring (e.g., pyridyl or furyl) or multiple condensed rings (e.g., indolizinyl or benzothienyl).
  • Preferred heteroaryls include pyridyl, pyrrolyl and furyl.
  • Heteroaryloxy refers to the group heteroaryl-O— where heteroaryl is as defined above including optionally substituted heteroaryl groups as also defined above.
  • Heterocycle or “heterocyclic” refers to a monovalent saturated or unsaturated group having a single ring or multiple condensed rings, from 1 to 10 carbon atoms and from 1 to 4 hetero atoms selected from nitrogen, sulfur or oxygen within the ring.
  • heterocyclic groups can be optionally substituted with 1 to 3 substituents selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, aryl, aryloxy, halo, nitro, heteroaryl, thioalkoxy, thioaryloxy and the like.
  • Such heterocyclic groups can have a single ring (e.g., piperidinyl or tetrahydrofuranyl) or multiple condensed rings.
  • heterocycles and heteroaryls include, but are not limited to, pyrrole, imidazole, pyrazole, pyridine, pyrazine, pyrimidine, pyridazine, indolizine, isoindole, indole, indazole, purine, quinolizine, isoquinoline, quinoline, phthalazine, naphthylpyridine, quinoxaline, quinazoline, cinnoline, pteridine, carbazole, carboline, phenanthridine, acridine, phenanthroline, isothiazole, phenazine, isoxazole, phenoxazine, phenothiazine, imidazolidine, imidazoline, piperidine, piperazine, indoline, phthalimide, 1,2,3,4-tetrahydroisoquinoline, 4,5,6,7-tetrahydrobenzo[b]thioph
  • Heterocyclyloxy refers to the group heterocyclic-O— where heterocyclic is as defined above including optionally substituted heterocyclic groups as also defined above.
  • Thiol refers to the group —SH.
  • Thioalkoxy refers to the groups —S-alkyl wherein alkyl is as defined above.
  • Thio-substituted alkoxy refers to the groups —S-substituted alkoxy wherein substituted alkoxy is as defined above.
  • Thioaryloxy refers to the group aryl-S— wherein the aryl group is as defined above including optionally substituted aryl groups as also defined above.
  • Thioheteroaryloxy refers to the group heteroaryl-S— wherein the heteroaryl group is as defined above including optionally substituted aryl groups as also defined above.
  • “Pharmaceutically acceptable salt” refers to pharmaceutically acceptable salts of a compound of Formula I which salts are derived from a variety of organic and inorganic counter ions well known in the art and include, by way of example only, sodium, potassium, calcium, magnesium, ammonium, tetraalkylammonium, and the like; and when the molecule contains a basic functionality, salts of organic or inorganic acids, such as hydrochloride, hydrobromide, tartrate, mesylate, acetate, maleate, oxalate and the like.
  • the compounds of formula I are readily prepared via several divergent synthetic routes with the particular route selected relative to the ease of compound preparation, commercial availability of starting materials, etc.
  • a first synthetic method involves conventional coupling of an acid derivative with a primary amine of an esterified amino acid as shown in reaction (1) below:
  • R 1 , R 2 , X′ and X′′ are as defined above, and R′ is preferably hydrogen or an alkyl group.
  • Reaction (1) merely involves coupling of a suitable acid derivative 1 with the primary amine of amino acid/amino acid ester 2 under conditions which provide for the N-acetyl derivative 3.
  • This reaction is conventionally conducted for peptide synthesis and synthetic methods used therein can also be employed to prepare the N-acetyl amino acid/amino acid esters 3.
  • well known coupling reagents such as carbodiimides with or without the use of well known additives such as N-hydroxysuccinimide, 1-hydroxybenzotriazole, etc. can be used to facilitate coupling.
  • the reaction is conventionally conducted in an inert aprotic diluent such as dimethylformamide, dichloromethane, chloroform, acetonitrile, tetrahydrofuran and the like.
  • the acid halide of compound 1 can be employed in reaction (1) and, when so employed, it is typically employed in the presence of a suitable base to scavenge the acid generated during the reaction.
  • suitable bases include, by way of example, triethylamine, diisopropylethylamine, N-methylmorpholine and the like.
  • Reaction (1) is preferably conducted at from about 0° C. to about 60° C. until reaction completion which typically occurs within 1 to about 24 hours.
  • reaction completion N-acetyl amino acid/amino acid ester 3 is recovered by conventional methods including precipitation, chromatography, filtration and the like or, alternatively in the case of the ester, is hydrolyzed to the corresponding carboxylic acid without purification and/or isolation other than conventional work-up (e.g., aqueous extraction, etc.).
  • an N-acetyl amino acid ester is formed, it is typically converted to the corresponding acid prior to coupling with an amine HNR 3 R 3′ .
  • Coupling is accomplished using well known peptide coupling chemistry with well known coupling reagents such as carbodiimides with or without the use of well known additives such as N-hydroxysuccinimide, 1-hydroxybenzotriazole, etc. which can be used to facilitate coupling.
  • the reaction is conventionally conducted in an inert aprotic polar diluent such as dimethylformamide, dichloromethane, chloroform, acetonitrile, tetrahydrofuran and the like.
  • the ester group of 3 can, in some cases, be converted directly into an amide group via conventional ester/amide exchange reactions which are well known in the art.
  • each of the reagents (acetic acid derivative 1 and amino acid/amino acid ester 2) are well known in the art with a plurality of each being commercially available.
  • the compounds of formula I can be prepared by first forming the amino acid amide then N′-acetylating these esters. That is to say that the amine HNR 3 R 3′ is coupled to the N′-blocked amino acid BlockNHCHR 2 COOH via conventional coupling conditions to provide for the N′-blocked amino acid amide BlockNHCHR 2 C(O)NR 3 R 3′ . The blocking group is then removed via conventional conditions to provide for the free amine which is then N′-acetylated in the manner described above to provide for the compounds of formula I.
  • the resulting amides can be derivatized via conventional chemistry to provide for derivatives of the synthesized compounds.
  • reactive functionality which is blocked on either R 2 and/or R 3 groups can be deblocked and then derivatized.
  • a Boc-protected amino group on R 2 e.g., lysine side chain
  • R 2 e.g., lysine side chain
  • the compounds described herein can also be prepared by use of polymer supported forms of carbodiimide peptide coupling reagents.
  • a polymer supported form of EDC for example, has been described ( Tetrahedron Letters, 34(48), 7685 (1993)) 10 .
  • a new carbodiimide coupling reagent, PEPC, and its corresponding polymer supported forms have been discovered and are very useful for the preparation of the compounds of the present invention.
  • Polymers suitable for use in making a polymer supported coupling reagent are either commercially available or may be prepared by methods well known to the artisan skilled in the polymer arts.
  • a suitable polymer must possess pendant sidechains bearing moieties reactive with the terminal amine of the carbodiimide. Such reactive moieties include chloro, bromo, iodo and methanesulfonyl. Preferably, the reactive moiety is a chloromethyl group.
  • the polymer's backbone must be inert to both the carbodiimide and reaction conditions under which the ultimate polymer bound coupling reagents will be used.
  • hydroxymethylated resins may be converted into chloromethylated resins useful for the preparation of polymer supported coupling reagents.
  • these hydroxylated resins include the 4-hydroxymethyl-phenylacetamidomethyl resin (Pam Resin) and 4-benzyloxybenzyl alcohol resin (Wang Resin) available from Advanced Chemtech of Louisville, Ky., USA (see Advanced Chemtech 1993-1994 catalog, page 115).
  • the hydroxymethyl groups of these resins may be converted into the desired chloromethyl groups by any of a number of methods well known to the skilled artisan.
  • Preferred resins are the chloromethylated styrene/divinylbenzene resins because of their ready commercial availability. As the name suggests, these resins are already chloromethylated and require no chemical modification prior to use. These resins are commercially known as Merrifield's resins and are available from Aldrich Chemical Company of Milwaukee, Wis., USA (see Aldrich 1994-1995 catalog, page 899). Methods for the preparation of PEPC and its polymer supported forms are outlined in the following scheme.
  • PEPC is prepared by first reacting ethyl isocyanate with 1-(3-aminopropyl)pyrrolidine. The resulting urea is treated with 4-toluenesulfonyl chloride to provide PEPC. The polymer supported form is prepared by reaction of PEPC with an appropriate resin under standard conditions to give the desired reagent.
  • the carboxylic acid coupling reactions employing these reagents are performed at about ambient temperature to about 45° C., for from about 3 to 120 hours.
  • the product may be isolated by washing the reaction with CHCl 3 and concentrating the remaining organics under reduced pressure. As discussed supra, isolation of products from reactions where a polymer bound reagent has been used is greatly simplified, requiring only filtration of the reaction mixture and then concentration of the filtrate under reduced pressure.
  • the starting materials can contain a chiral center (e.g., L-alanine) and, when a racemic starting material is employed, the resulting product is a mixture of R,S enatiomers.
  • a chiral isomer of the starting material can be employed and, if the reaction protocol employed does not racernized this starting material, a chiral product is obtained.
  • Such reaction protocols can involve inversion of the chiral center during synthesis.
  • the products of this invention are a mixture of R,S enatiomers.
  • the chiral product corresponds to the L-amino acid derivative.
  • chiral products can be obtained via purification techniques which separates enatiomers from an R,S mixture to provide for one or the other stereoisomer. Such techniques are well known in the art.
  • the compounds of formula I are usually administered in the form of pharmaceutical compositions. These compounds can be administered by a variety of routes including oral, rectal, transdermal, subcutaneous, intravenous, intramuscular, and intranasal. These compounds are effective as both injectable and oral compositions. Such compositions are prepared in a manner well known in the pharmaceutical art and comprise at least one active compound.
  • compositions which contain, as the active ingredient, one or more of the compounds of formula I above associated with pharmaceutically acceptable carriers.
  • the active ingredient is usually mixed with an excipient, diluted by an excipient or enclosed within such a carrier which can be in the form of a capsule, sachet, paper or other container.
  • the excipient serves as a diluent, it can be a solid, semi-solid, or liquid material, which acts as a vehicle, carrier or medium for the active ingredient.
  • compositions can be in the form of tablets, pills, powders, lozenges, sachets, cachets, elixirs, suspensions, emulsions, solutions, syrups, aerosols (as a solid or in a liquid medium), ointments containing, for example, up to 10% by weight of the active compound, soft and hard gelatin capsules, suppositories, sterile injectable solutions, and sterile packaged powders.
  • the active compound In preparing a formulation, it may be necessary to mill the active compound to provide the appropriate particle size prior to combining with the other ingredients. If the active compound is substantially insoluble, it ordinarily is milled to a particle size of less than 200 mesh. If the active compound is substantially water soluble, the particle size is normally adjusted by milling to provide a substantially uniform distribution in the formulation, e.g., about 40 mesh.
  • excipients include lactose, dextrose, sucrose, sorbitol, mannitol, starches, gum acacia, calcium phosphate, alginates, tragacanth, gelatin, calcium silicate, microcrystalline cellulose, polyvinylpyrrolidone, cellulose, sterile water, syrup, and methyl cellulose.
  • the formulations can additionally include: lubricating agents such as talc, magnesium stearate, and mineral oil; wetting agents; emulsifying and suspending agents; preserving agents such as methyl- and propylhydroxy-benzoates; sweetening agents; and flavoring agents.
  • the compositions of the invention can be formulated so as to provide quick, sustained or delayed release of the active ingredient after administration to the patient by employing procedures known in the art.
  • compositions are preferably formulated in a unit dosage form, each dosage containing from about 5 to about 100 mg, more usually about 10 to about 30 mg, of the active ingredient.
  • unit dosage forms refers to physically discrete units suitable as unitary dosages for human subjects and other mammals, each unit containing a predetermined quantity of active material calculated to produce the desired therapeutic effect, in association with a suitable pharmaceutical excipient.
  • the compound of formula I above is employed at no more than about 20 weight percent of the pharmaceutical composition, more preferably no more than about 15 weight percent, with the balance being pharmaceutically inert carrier(s).
  • the active compound is effective over a wide dosage range and is generally administered in a pharmaceutically effective amount. It will be understood, however, that the amount of the compound actually administered will be determined by a physician, in the light of the relevant circumstances, including the condition to be treated, the chosen route of administration, the actual compound administered, the age, weight, and response of the individual patient, the severity of the patient's symptoms, and the like.
  • the principal active ingredient is mixed with a pharmaceutical excipient to form a solid preformulation composition containing a homogeneous mixture of a compound of the present invention.
  • a solid preformulation composition containing a homogeneous mixture of a compound of the present invention.
  • the active ingredient is dispersed evenly throughout the composition so that the composition may be readily subdivided into equally effective unit dosage forms such as tablets, pills and capsules.
  • This solid preformulation is then subdivided into unit dosage forms of the type described above containing from, for example, 0.1 to about 500 mg of the active ingredient of the present invention.
  • the tablets or pills of the present invention may be coated or otherwise compounded to provide a dosage form affording the advantage of prolonged action.
  • the tablet or pill can comprise an inner dosage and an outer dosage component, the latter being in the form of an envelope over the former.
  • the two components can be separated by an enteric layer which serves to resist disintegration in the stomach and permit the inner component to pass intact into the duodenum or to be delayed in release.
  • enteric layers or coatings such materials including a number of polymeric acids and mixtures of polymeric acids with such materials as shellac, cetyl alcohol, and cellulose acetate.
  • liquid forms in which the novel compositions of the present invention may be incorporated for administration orally or by injection include aqueous solutions, suitably flavored syrups, aqueous or oil suspensions, and flavored emulsions with edible oils such as cottonseed oil, sesame oil, coconut oil, or peanut oil, as well as elixirs and similar pharmaceutical vehicles.
  • compositions for inhalation or insufflation include solutions and suspensions in pharmaceutically acceptable, aqueous or organic solvents, or mixtures thereof, and powders.
  • the liquid or solid compositions may contain suitable pharmaceutically acceptable excipients as described supra.
  • the compositions are administered by the oral or nasal respiratory route for local or systemic effect.
  • Compositions in preferably pharmaceutically acceptable solvents may be nebulized by use of inert gases. Nebulized solutions may be inhaled directly from the nebulizing device or the nebulizing device may be attached to a face masks tent, or intermittent positive pressure breathing machine. Solution, suspension, or powder compositions may be administered, preferably orally or nasally, from devices which deliver the formulation in an appropriate manner.
  • Hard gelatin capsules containing the following ingredients are prepared:
  • Quantity Ingredient (mg/capsule) Active Ingredient 30.0 Starch 305.0 Magnesium stearate 5.0
  • the above ingredients are mixed and filled into hard gelatin capsules in 340 mg quantities.
  • a tablet formula is prepared using the ingredients below:
  • Quantity Ingredient (mg/tablet) Active Ingredient 25.0 Cellulose, microcrystalline 200.0 Colloidal silicon dioxide 10.0 Stearic acid 5.0
  • the components are blended and compressed to form tablets, each weighing 240 mg.
  • a dry powder inhaler formulation is prepared containing the following components:
  • the active mixture is mixed with the lactose and the mixture is added to a dry powder inhaling appliance.
  • Tablets each containing 30 mg of active ingredient, are prepared as follows:
  • Quantity Ingredient (mg/tablet) Active Ingredient 30.0 mg Starch 45.0 mg Microcrystalline cellulose 35.0 mg Polyvinylpyrrolidone 4.0 mg (as 10% solution in sterile water) Sodium carboxymethyl starch 4.5 mg Magnesium stearate 0.5 mg Talc 1.0 mg Total 120 mg
  • the active ingredient, starch and cellulose are passed through a No. 20 mesh U.S. sieve and mixed thoroughly.
  • the solution of polyvinylpyrrolidone is mixed with the resultant powders, which are then passed through a 16 mesh U.S. sieve.
  • the granules so produced are dried at 50° to 60° C. and passed through a 16 mesh U.S. sieve.
  • the sodium carboxymethyl starch, magnesium stearate, and talc previously passed through a No. 30 mesh U.S. sieve, are then added to the granules which, after mixing, are compressed on a tablet machine to yield tablets each weighing 150 mg.
  • Capsules each containing 40 mg of medicament are made as follows:
  • Quantity Ingredient (mg/capsule) Active Ingredient 40.0 mg Starch 109.0 mg Magnesium stearate 1.0 mg Total 150.0 mg
  • the active ingredient, cellulose, starch, an magnesium stearate are blended, passed through a No. 20 mesh U.S. sieve, and filled into hard gelatin capsules in 150 mg quantities.
  • Suppositories each containing 25 mg of active ingredient are made as follows:
  • Ingredient Amount Active Ingredient 25 mg Saturated fatty acid glycerides to 2,000 mg
  • the active ingredient is passed through a No. 60 mesh U.S. sieve and suspended in the saturated fatty acid glycerides previously melted using the minimum heat necessary. The mixture is then poured into a suppository mold of nominal 2.0 g capacity and allowed to cool.
  • Suspensions each containing 50 mg of medicament per 5.0 ml dose are made as follows:
  • Ingredient Amount Active Ingredient 50.0 mg Xanthan gum 4.0 mg Sodium carboxymethyl cellulose (11%) 50.0 mg Microcrystalline cellulose (89%) Sucrose 1.75 g Sodium benzoate 10.0 mg Flavor and Color q.v. Purified water to 5.0 ml
  • the medicament, sucrose and xanthan gum are blended, passed through a No. 10 mesh U.S. sieve, and then mixed with a previously made solution of the microcrystalline cellulose and sodium carboxymethyl cellulose in water.
  • the sodium benzoate, flavor, and color are diluted with some of the water and added with stirring. Sufficient water is then added to produce the required volume.
  • Quantity Ingredient (mg/capsule) Active Ingredient 15.0 mg Starch 407.0 mg Magnesium stearate 3.0 mg Total 425.0 mg
  • the active ingredient, cellulose, starch, and magnesium stearate are blended, passed through a No. 20 mesh U.S. sieve, and filled into hard gelatin capsules in 560 mg quantities.
  • a subcutaneous formulation may be prepared as follows:
  • a topical formulation may be prepared as follows:
  • Ingredient Quantity Active Ingredient 1-10 g Emulsifying Wax 30 g Liquid Paraffin 20 g White Soft Paraffin to 100 g
  • the white soft paraffin is heated until molten.
  • the liquid paraffin and emulsifying wax are incorporated and stirred until dissolved.
  • the active ingredient is added and stirring is continued until dispersed.
  • the mixture is then cooled until solid.
  • transdermal delivery devices Such transdermal patches may be used to provide continuous or discontinuous infusion of the compounds of the present invention in controlled amounts.
  • the construction and use of transdermal patches for the delivery of pharmaceutical agents is well known in the art. See. e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 5,023,252, issued Jun. 11, 1991, herein incorporated by reference.
  • patches may be constructed for continuous, pulsatile, or on demand delivery of pharmaceutical agents.
  • Indirect techniques usually involve formulating the compositions to provide for drug latentiation by the conversion of hydrophilic drugs into lipid-soluble drugs.
  • Latentiation is generally achieved through blocking of the hydroxy, carbonyl, sulfate, and primary amine groups present on the drug to render the drug more lipid soluble and amenable to transportation across the blood-brain barrier.
  • the delivery of hydrophilic drugs may be enhanced by intra-arterial infusion of hypertonic solutions which can transiently open the blood-brain barrier.
  • the compounds and pharmaceutical compositions of the invention are useful in inhibiting, ⁇ -amyloid peptide release and/or its synthesis, and, accordingly, have utility in treating Alzheimer's disease in mammals including humans.
  • the compounds described herein are suitable for use in a variety of drug delivery systems described above. Additionally, in order to enhance the in vivo serum half-life of the administered compound, the compounds may be encapsulated, introduced into the lumen of liposomes, prepared as a colloid, or other conventional techniques may be employed which provide an extended serum half-life of the compounds.
  • a variety of methods are available for preparing liposomes, as described in, e.g., Szoka, et al., U.S. Pat. Nos. 4,235,871, 4,501,728 and 4,837,028 each of which is incorporated herein by reference.
  • compositions are administered to a patient already suffering from AD in an amount sufficient to at least partially arrest further onset of the symptoms of the disease and its complications.
  • An amount adequate to accomplish this is defined as “therapeutically effective dose.” Amounts effective for this use will depend on the judgment of the attending clinician depending upon factors such as the degree or severity of AD in the patient, the age, weight and general condition of the patient, and the like.
  • the compounds described herein are administered at dosages ranging from about 1 to about 500 mg/kg/day.
  • compositions are administered to a patient at risk of developing AD (determined for example by genetic screening or familial trait) in an amount sufficient to inhibit the onset of symptoms of the disease.
  • An amount adequate to accomplish this is defined as “prophylactically effective dose.” Amounts effective for this use will depend on the judgment of the attending clinician depending upon factors such as the age, weight and general condition of the patient, and the like.
  • the compounds described herein are administered at dosages ranging from about 1 to about 500 mg/kg/day.
  • the compounds administered to a patient are in the form of pharmaceutical compositions described above. These compositions may be sterilized by conventional sterilization techniques, or may be sterile filtered. The resulting aqueous solutions may be packaged for use as is, or lyophilized, the lyophilized preparation being combined with a sterile aqueous carrier prior to administration.
  • the pH of the compound preparations typically will be between 3 and 11, more preferably from 5 to 9 and most preferably from 7 and 8. It will be understood that use of certain of the foregoing excipients, carriers, or stabilizers will result in the formation of pharmaceutical salts.
  • BOP benzotriazol-1-yloxy-tris(dimethylamino)phosphonium hexafluorophosphate
  • bd broad doublet
  • bs broad singlet
  • cc concentration (g/mL)
  • CDI 1,1′-carbonyldiimidazole
  • d doublet
  • dd doublet of doublets
  • DMAP dimethylaminopyridine
  • DMF dimethylformamide
  • DMSO dimethylsulfoxide
  • EDC 1-(3-dimethylamiopropyl)-3-ethylcarbodiimide hydrochloride
  • EDTA ethylene diamine tetraacetic acid eq.
  • the amino acid ester was dissolved in dioxane/water (4:1) to which was added LiOH ( ⁇ 2 eq.) that was dissolved in water such that the total solvent after addition was about 2:1 dioxane:water.
  • the reaction mixture was stirred until reaction completion and the dioxane was removed under reduced pressure.
  • the residue was diluted with EtOAc, the layers were separated and the aqueous layer acidified to pH 2.
  • the aqueous layer was back extracted with EtOAc, the combined organics were dried over Na 2 SO 4 and the solvent was removed under reduced pressure after filtration.
  • the residue was purified by conventional methods (e.g., recrystallization).
  • the acid derivative was dissolved in methylene chloride.
  • the amine (1 eq.), N-methylmorpholine (5 eq.), and hydroxybenzotriazole monohydrate (1.2 eq.) were added in sequence.
  • the reaction was cooled to about 0° C. and then 1.2 eq. of 1-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-3-ethylcarbodiimide hydrochloride was added.
  • the solution was allowed to stir overnight and come to room temperature under N 2 pressure.
  • the reaction mix was worked up by washing the solution with saturated, aqueous Na 2 CO 3 , 0.1M citric acid, and brine before drying with Na 2 SO 4 and removal of solvents to yield crude product. Pure products were obtained by flash chromatography in an appropriate solvent.
  • P-EPC coupling employs an amino acid ester and a substituted acetic acid compound.
  • the acetic acid derivative is well known in the art and is typically commercially available.
  • the amino acid ester is prepared by conventional methods from the known and typically commercially available N-BOC amino acid as described in GENERAL PROCEDURE J′ below.
  • N-BOC amino acid was dissolved in dioxane and treated with an excess of alcohol ( ⁇ 1.5 eq.) and catalytic DMAP (100 mg) at 0° C. Stirring was continued until reaction completion whereupon the product was recovered by conventional methods.
  • the N-BOC protected amino acid was dissolved in methylene chloride (0.05M) and treated with 10 eq. of TFA at room temperature under a nitrogen atmosphere. The reaction was monitored by tlc until starting material was consumed usually within 1-5 hours. An additional 10 eq. of TFA was added to the reaction if the starting material was still present after 5 hours. The reaction was carefully neutralized with Na 2 CO 3 , separated, the organic layer washed with brine and dried over anhydrous Na 2 SO 4 . The crude amine was then used without purification.
  • amino acid (amino acid or amino acid hydrochloride) is suspended in methanol and chilled to 0° C. HCl gas is bubbled through this solution for 5 minutes. The reaction is allowed to warm to room temperature then stirred for 4 hours. The solvents are then removed at reduced pressure to afford the desired amino acid methyl ester hydrochloride. This product is usually used without further purification.
  • the crude sulfonate was dissolved in 50 mL of DMF at 0° C. and then 3 g of KCN was added. After 2 hours an additional 50 mL of DMF was added and the solution was stirred for 16 hours.
  • the red solution was diluted with 1 L of H 2 O and acidified to pH 3 with 3N HCl.
  • the aqueous solution was extracted with dichloromethane. The combined organics were washed with 3N HCl, dried with Na 2 SO 4 and the solvents removed at reduced pressure to yield crude 3,5-dichlorophenylacetonitrile which was used without purification.
  • the nitrile was added to a mixture of 40 mL of concentrated sulfuric acid and 50 mL H 2 O and heated to reflux for 48 hours, cooled to room temperature and stirred for 48 hours.
  • the reaction was diluted into 1 L of crushed ice, warmed to toom temperature and extracted with 2 ⁇ 200 mL of dichloromethane and 2 ⁇ 200 mL of ethylacetate. Both sets of organics were combined and washed with saturated aqueous NaHCO 3 .
  • the NaHCO 3 fractions were combined and acidified to pH 1 with 3N HCl.
  • the white solid was too fine to filter and was extracted out with 2 ⁇ 200 mL of dichloromethane.
  • N-phenylacetyl-L-methionine (0.1285 g, 0.447 mmol) was dissolved in 3.0 mL dioxane and iso-butyl alcohol (0.2 mL) and treated with EDC (0.094 g, 0.492 mmol), and catalytic DMAP (0.015 g). After stirring for 17 hours at 23° C., the mixture was evaporated at reduced pressure to an oil, the residue was diluted in EtOAc and washed with 0.1 N HCl and saturated sodium bicarbonate. Chromatography on silica gel using 98:2 CHCl 3 /MeOH as eluant provided the pure product.
  • N-Phenylacetyl-L-leucine (0.0081 g, 0.038 mmol) was dissolved in 2.0 mL CHCl 3 (EtOH free) and iso-butyl alcohol (0.055 mL) and treated with P-EPC (100 mg, 0.87 milliequivalents). The mixture was rotated for 4 days, filtered through a plug of cotton and the filtrate evaporated at reduced pressure to an oil which was sufficiently pure for testing.
  • Methyl (S)-(+)-2-hydroxy-2-methylbutyrate was then coupled with carbobenzyloxy-L-alanine (Aldrich) using General Procedure E′ to provide carbobenzyloxy-L-alanine S-1-(methoxycarbonyl) iso-butyl ester.
  • Carbobenzyloxy-L-alanine S-1-(methoxycarbonyl) iso-butyl ester (1.0 g) was then dissolved in 20 mL of methanol and 6N HCl (0.5 mL) and 10% palladium on carbon (0.1 g) were added. This reaction mixture was hydrogenated at 40 psi of hydrogen on a Parr apparatus for 5 hours at room temperature and then filtered through a pad of Celite. The filtrate was concentrated at reduced pressure to provide L-alanine S-1-(methoxycarbonyl) iso-butyl ester hydrochloride (98% yield).
  • the resulting compound was placed in a large excess of the desired alcohol. A catalytic amount of dry NaH was added, and the reaction was followed by tlc until the presence of starting material was no longer detected. The reaction was quenched with a few milliliters of 1N HCl, and after a few minutes of stirring saturated aqueous NaHCO, was added. The volume of the reaction mixture was reduced on a rotary evaporator until the excess alcohol was removed and then the remaining residue was taken up in ethyl acetate and additional water was added. The organic phase was washed with saturated aqueous NaCl and dried over MgSO 4 . The solution was stripped free of solvent on a rotary evaporator, and the crude product residue was then further purified by chromatography.
  • 3,5-Difluorophenylacetic acid (30 g, 0.174 mol) (Aldrich) was dissolved in dichloromethane and this solution was cooled to 0° C. DMF (0.5 mL, catalytic) was added followed by the dropwise addition of oxalyl chloride (18 mL, 0.20 mol) over a 5 minute period. The reaction was stirred for 3 h and then rotoevaporated at reduced pressure to a residue which was placed on a high vacuum pump for 1 h to afford 3,5-difluorophenylacetyl chloride as a thin yellow oil.
  • Other acid chlorides can be prepared in a similar manner.
  • title compound was prepared from phenylacetyl chloride (Aldrich) and L-alanine (Aldrich) as a solid having a melting point of 102-104° C.
  • the solvent was removed at reduced pressure and the residue taken up in EtOAc (or a similar solvent)/H 2 O.
  • the extracts were washed with saturated NaHCO 3, 1 N aqueous hydrochloric acid, brine and dried over Na 2 SO 4 .
  • the isolated product required further purification using standard procedures, such as chromatography and/or recrystallization.
  • the solvent was removed at reduced pressure and the residue taken up in EtOAc (or a similar solvent)/H 2 O.
  • the extracts were washed with saturated NaHCO 3 , 1 N aqueous hydrochloric acid, brine and dried over Na 2 SO 4 .
  • the isolated product required further purification using standard procedures, such as chromatography and/or recrystallization.
  • 2-Amino-1-pentanol was stirred in a mixture of chloroform and saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate.
  • Di-tert-butyl dicarbonate (1.05 eq.) was added in one portion and the mixture was stirred until starting material was consumed.
  • the organic portion was separated, dried (sodium sulfate) and concentrated.
  • the crude material was purified by silica gel chromatography using 1:1 ethyl acetate/hexanes.
  • the crystalline product was stirred in dry DMF and potassium phthalimide (1.1 eq.) was added. The mixture was stirred for 18 h then was concentrated under reduced pressure. The residue was partitioned between ethyl acetate and water. The organic portion was dried and concentrated to yield a white solid. The solid was taken up in chloroform and filtered through a plug of silica. Eluent containing product was concentrated to yield the crude product as a white solid.
  • the white solid was taken up in dry dioxane and the resulting solution was saturated with gaseous HCl. After stirring for 30 minutes, the mixture was concentrated to yield a white solid which was titrated in ether. The title compound was collected, washed with ether and dried in a vacuum oven.
  • Example B2 N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alanine (Example B2) in dichloromethane was coupled to (methyl 2-(aminomethyl)-benzeneacetate hydrochloride using EDC, HOBT, DIEA to provide for the title compound.
  • the title compound was prepared by following the procedure set forth in Example 22 but substituting (methyl 3-(aminomethyl)-benzeneacetate hydrochloride for (methyl 3-(aminomethyl)-benzoate hydrochloride.
  • This mutation is commonly called the Swedish mutation and the cells, designated as “293 751 SWE”, were plated in Corning 96-well plates at 1.5-2.5 ⁇ 10 4 cells per well in Dulbecco's minimal essential media plus 10% fetal bovine serum. Cell number is important in order to achieve ⁇ -amyloid ELISA results within the linear range of the assay ( ⁇ 0.2 to 2.5 ng per mL).

Abstract

Disclosed are compounds which inhibit β-amyloid peptide release and/or its synthesis, and, accordingly, have utility in treating Alzheimer's disease. Also disclosed pharmaceutical compositions comprising a compound which inhibits β-amyloid peptide release and/or its synthesis as well as methods for treating Alzheimer's disease both prophylactically and therapeutically with such pharmaceutical compositions.

Description

CROSS-REFERENCE TO RELATED APPLICATIONS
This application claims the benefit of the following U.S. Provisional Applications:
1. U.S. Provisional Application No. 60/098,551, which was converted pursuant to 37 C.F.R. §1.53(b)(2)(ii) from U.S. patent application Ser. No. 08/754,895, filed Nov. 22, 1996; and
2. U.S. Provisional Application No. 60/113,671, which was converted pursuant to 37 C.F.R. §1.53(b)(2)(ii) from U.S. patent application Ser. No. 08/807,538, filed Feb. 28, 1997,
which are incorporated by reference in their entirety.
This application is a continuation, of application Ser. No. 08/976,295, filed Nov. 21, 1997, now U.S. Pat. No. 6,153,652.
BACKGROUND OF THE INVENTION
1. Field of the Invention
This invention relates to compounds which inhibit cellular β-amyloid peptide release and/or its synthesis, and, accordingly, have utility in treating Alzheimer's disease. This invention also relates to pharmaceutical compositions comprising such compounds as well as methods for inhibiting release of β-amyloid peptide.
2. References
The following publications, patents and patent applications are cited in this application as superscript numbers:
1 Glenner, et al., “Alzheimer's Disease: Initial Report of the Purification and Characterization of a Novel Cerebrovascular Amyloid Protein”, Biochem. Biophys. Res. Commnun., 120:885-890 (1984).
2 Glenner, et al., “Polypeptide Marker for Alzheimer's Disease and its Use for Diagnosis”, U.S. Pat. No. 4,666,829 issued May 19, 1987.
3 Selkoe, “The Molecular Pathology of Alzheimer's Disease”, Neuron, 6:487-498 (1991).
4 Goate, et al., “Segregation of a Missense Mutation in the Amyloid Precursor Protein Gene with Familial Alzheimer's Disease”, Nature, 349:704-706 (1990).
5 Chartier-Harlan, et al., “Early-Onset Alzheimer's Disease Caused by Mutations at Codon 717 of the β-Amyloid Precursor Proteing Gene”, Nature, 353:844-846 (1989).
6 Murrell, et al., “A Mutation in the Amyloid Precursor Protein Associated with Hereditary Alzheimer's Disease”, Science, 254:97-99 (1991).
7 Mullan, et al., “A Pathogenic Mutation for Probable Alzheimer's Disease in the APP Gene at the N-Terminus of β-Amyloid, Nature Genet., 1:345-347 (1992).
8 Schenk, et al., “Methods and Compositions for the Detection of Soluble β-Amyloid Peptide”, International Patent Application Publication No. WO 94/10569, published May 11, 1994.
9Selkoe, “Amyloid Protein and Alzheimer's Disease”, Scientific American, pp. 2-8, November, 1991.
10 Tetrahedron Letters, 34(48), 7685 (1993)
11 Losse, et al., Tetrahedron, 27:1423-1434 (1971)
12 Citron, et al., “Mutation of the β-Amyloid Precursor Protein in Familial Alzheimer's Disease Increases β-Protein Production, Nature, 360:672-674 (1992).
13 Hansen, et al., “Reexamination and Further Development of a Precise and Rapid Dye Method for Measuring Cell Growth/Cell Kill”, J. Immun. Meth., 119:203-210 (1989).
All of the above publications, patents and patent applications are herein incorporated by reference in their entirety to the same extent as if each individual publication, patent or patent application was specifically and individually indicated to be incorporated by reference in its entirety.
3. State of the Art
Alzheimer's Disease (AD) is a degenerative brain disorder characterized clinically by progressive loss of memory, cognition, reasoning, judgment and emotional stability that gradually leads to profound mental deterioration and ultimately death. AD is a very common cause of progressive mental failure (dementia) in aged humans and is believed to represent the fourth most common medical cause of death in the United States. AD has been observed in races and ethnic groups worldwide and presents a major present and future public health problem. The disease is currently estimated to affect about two to three million individuals in the United States alone. AD is at present incurable. No treatment that effectively prevents AD or reverses its symptoms and course is currently known.
The brains of individuals with AD exhibit characteristic lesions termed senile (or amyloid) plaques, amyloid angiopathy (amyloid deposits in blood vessels) and neurofibrillary tangles. Large numbers of these lesions, particularly amyloid plaques and neurofibrillary tangles, are generally found in several areas of the human brain important for memory and cognitive function in patients with AD. Smaller numbers of these lesions in a more restrictive anatomical distribution are also found in the brains of most aged humans who do not have clinical AD. Amyloid plaques and amyloid angiopathy also characterize the brains of individuals with Trisomy 21 (Down's Syndrome) and Hereditary Cerebral Hemorrhage with Amyloidosis of the Dutch Type (HCHWA-D). At present, a definitive diagnosis of AD usually requires observing the aforementioned lesions in the brain tissue of patients who have died with the disease or, rarely, in small biopsied samples of brain tissue taken during an invasive neurosurgical procedure.
The principal chemical constituent of the amyloid plaques and vascular amyloid deposits (amyloid angiopathy) characteristic of AD and the other disorders mentioned above is an approximately 4.2 kilodalton (kD) protein of about 39-43 amino acids designated the β-amyloid peptide (βAP) or sometimes Aβ, AβP or β/A4. β-Amyloid peptide was first purified and a partial amino acid sequence was provided by Glenner, et al.1 The isolation procedure and the sequence data for the first 28 amino acids are described in U.S. Pat. No. 4,666,8292.
Molecular biological and protein chemical analyses have shown that the β-amyloid peptide is a small fragment of a much larger precursor protein (APP), that is normally produced by cells in many tissues of various animals, including humans. Knowledge of the structure of the gene encoding the APP has demonstrated that β-amyloid peptide arises as a peptide fragment that is cleaved from APP by protease enzyme(s). The precise biochemical mechanism by which the β-amyloid peptide fragment is cleaved from APP and subsequently deposited as amyloid plaques in the cerebral tissue and in the walls of the cerebral and meningeal blood vessels is currently unknown.
Several lines of evidence indicate that progressive cerebral deposition of β-amyloid peptide plays a seminal role in the pathogenesis of AD and can precede cognitive symptoms by years or decades. See, for example, Selkoe3. The most important line of evidence is the discovery that missense DNA mutations at amino acid 717 of the 770-amino acid isoform of APP can be found in affected members but not unaffected members of several families with a genetically determined (familial) form of AD (Goate, et al.4; Chartier Harlan, et al.5; and Murrell, et al.6) and is referred to as the Swedish variant. A double mutation changing lysine595-methionine596 to asparagine595-leucine596 (with reference to the 695 isoform) found in a Swedish family was reported in 1992 (Mullan, et al.7). Genetic linkage analyses have demonstrated that these mutations, as well as certain other mutations in the APP gene, are the specific molecular cause of AD in the affected members of such families. In addition, a mutation at amino acid 693 of the 770-amino acid isoform of APP has been identified as the cause of the β-amyloid peptide deposition disease, HCHWA-D, and a change from alanine to glycine at amino acid 692 appears to cause a phenotype that resembles AD is some patients but HCHWA-D in others. The discovery of these and other mutations in APP in genetically based cases of AD prove that alteration of APP and subsequent deposition of its β-amyloid peptide fragment can cause AD.
Despite the progress which has been made in understanding the underlying mechanisms of AD and other β-amyloid peptide related diseases, there remains a need to develop methods and compositions for treatment of the disease(s). Ideally, the treatment methods would advantageously be based on drugs which are capable of inhibiting β-amyloid peptide release and/or its synthesis in vivo.
SUMMARY OF THE INVENTION
This invention is directed to the discovery of a class of compounds which inhibit β-amyloid peptide release and/or its synthesis and, therefore, are useful in the prevention of AD in patients susceptible to AD and/or in the treatment of patients with AD in order to inhibit further deterioration in their condition. The class of compounds having the described properties are defined by formula I below:
Figure US06262302-20010717-C00001
wherein R1 is selected from the group consisting of
a) alkyl, alkenyl, alkaryl, alkcycloalkyl, aryl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, heteroaryl and heterocyclic wherein the heteroaryl or heterocyclic group is optionally substituted with 1 to 3 substituents selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, aryl, aryloxy, halo, nitro, thioalkoxy, and thioaryloxy;
(b) a substituted phenyl group of formula II:
Figure US06262302-20010717-C00002
wherein R is alkylene of from 1 to 8 carbon atoms,
m is an integer equal to 0 or 1,
Ra and Ra′ are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, hydroxy, fluoro and methyl;
Rb and Rb′ are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkoxy, aryl, aryloxy, cyano, cycloalkyl, halo, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heterocyclic, nitro, trihalomethyl, thioalkoxy, thioaryloxy, thioheteroaryloxy, and —C(O)R4 where R4 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, aryl, alkoxy and aryloxy; and
Rc is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, aryl, cyano, halo, nitro, and where Rb and Rc are fused to form a methylenedioxy ring with the phenyl ring; and
when Rb and/or Rb′ and/or Rc is fluoro, chloro, bromo and/or nitro, then Ra and/or Ra′ can also be chloro; and
(c) 1- or 2-naphthyl substituted at the 5, 6, 7 and/or 8 positions with 1 to 4 substituents selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halo, cyano, nitro, trihalomethyl, and thioalkoxy;
R2 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl of from 1 to 4 carbon atoms, alkylalkoxy of from 1 to 4 carbon atoms, alkylthioalkoxy of from 1 to 4 carbon atoms; and
R3 and R3′ are independently selected from the group consisting of:
(a) hydrogen with the proviso that both R3 and R3′ cannot be hydrogen;
(b) alkyl with the proviso that when R3 is hydrogen, then the R3′ alkyl group has a linear carbon chain length of at least 5 carbon atoms from the nitrogen atom which chain can be optionally substituted with one or more alkyl groups and with the further proviso that when both R3 and R3′ are alkyl then at least one of the alkyl group has a carbon chain length of at least 5 carbon atoms which chain can be optionally substituted with one or more alkyl groups;
(c) —(R7)n (W)p wherein R7 is an alkylene group, W is selected from the group consisting of:
Figure US06262302-20010717-C00003
where R5, R5′, R9 and R9′ are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, hydroxyl, alkyl, substituted alkyl, alkoxy, substituted alkoxy, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, aryl, acyl, acylamino, acyloxy, aminoacyl, cyano, cycloalkyl, halogen, carboxyl, carboxyl esters, heteroaryl and heterocyclic; and
R6 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, hydroxyl, alkyl, substituted alkyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, aryl, acyl, acylamino, acyloxy, alkoxy, substituted alkoxy, aminoacyl, cyano, cycloalkyl, halogen, carboxyl, carboxyl esters, heteroaryl, heterocyclic and where R6 and one of R5 or R5′ are fused to from a heterocyclic ring of from 4 to 10 atoms having from 1 to 3 heteroatoms selected from the group consisting of oxygen, nitrogen and sulfur;
with the proviso that when n is zero, R9 and R9′ are hydrogen;
(ii) heteroaryl; and
(iii) N-heterocyclic with the proviso that when W is N-heterocyclic then n is not zero; and
n is an integer equal to 0 or 1, and p2 p is an integer equal to 1 to 3 with the proviso that when n is zero then p is equal to 1, and
(d) —CH(φ)CH2C(O)O—Q where Q is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, aryl, heteroaryl and heterocyclic
X′ is hydrogen, hydroxy or fluoro;
X″ is hydrogen, hydroxy or fluoro, or X′ and X″ together form an oxo group,
Z is selected from the group consisting of a bond covalently linking R1 to —CX′X″—, oxygen and sulfur; and
with the proviso that when R1 is phenyl, R2 is methyl, X′ and X″ are hydrogen, Z is a group covalently linking R1 to —CX′X″—, m is zero, R3 is hydrogen, R3′ is —(R7)n (W)p where n is zero and p is one and W is
Figure US06262302-20010717-C00004
then (i) R5, R5′, R9, R9′ and R6 are not all hydrogen and (ii) R5, R5′, R9, R9′ are hydrogen and R6 is methoxy;
with the further proviso that when R1 is 3,5-difluorophenyl, R2 is methyl, X′ and X″ are hydrogen, Z is a group covalently lining R1 to —CX′X″—, m is zero, R3 is hydrogen, R3′ is —(R7)n (W)p where n is one and p is one, R7 is ethylene and W is
Figure US06262302-20010717-C00005
then R5, R5′, R9, R9′ and R6 are not all hydrogen; and
with still the further proviso that when R1 is 3,5-difluorophenyl, R2 is methyl, X′ and X″ are hydrogen, Z is a group covalently linking R1 to —CX′X″—, and m is zero, R3 is hydrogen, R3′ is —(R7)n (W)p where n is zero and p is one, W is
Figure US06262302-20010717-C00006
and R5′, R9, R9′ are hydrogen, then R5 and R6 are not fused to form, with the phenyl ring to which they are attached, a phthalimido group.
Accordingly, in one of its method aspects, this invention is directed to a method for inhibiting β-amyloid peptide release and/or its synthesis in a cell which method comprises administering to such a cell an amount of a compound or a mixture of compounds of formula I above effective in inhibiting the cellular release and/or synthesis of β-amyloid peptide.
Because the in vivo generation of β-amyloid peptide is associated with the pathogenesis of AD8,9, the compounds of formula I can also be employed in conjunction with a pharmaceutical composition to prophylactically and/or therapeutically prevent and/or treat AD. Accordingly, in another of its method aspects, this invention is directed to a prophylactic method for preventing the onset of AD in a patient at risk for developing AD which method comprises administering to said patient a pharmaceutical composition comprising a pharmaceutically inert carrier and an effective amount of a compound or a mixture of compounds of formula I above.
In yet another of its method aspects, this invention is directed to a therapeutic method for treating a patient with AD in order to inhibit further deterioration in the condition of that patient which method comprises administering to said patient a pharmaceutical composition comprising a pharmaceutically inert carrier and an effective amount of a compound or a mixture of compounds of formula I above.
In formula I above, preferred R1 unsubstituted aryl groups include, for example, phenyl, 1-naphthyl, 2-naphthyl, and the like.
Preferred R1 substituted aryl groups include, for example, monosubstituted phenyls having a single substitution at the 2, 3 or 4 positions where each of the particular subsituents is governed by the respective Ra, Rb and Rc groups; disubstituted phenyls which include those having two substituents at the 2,3-positions, 2,4-positions, 2,5-positions, 2,6-positions, 3,4-positions, 3,5-positions or 3,6-positions where each of these substituents is governed by the respective Ra, Ra′, Rb, Rb′ and Rc groups; and trisubstituted phenyls which include those having three substituents at the 2,3,4-positions, 2,3,5-positions, 2,3,6-positions, 3,4,5-positions and 3,4,6-positions again where each of these substituents is governed by the respective Ra, Ra′, Rb, Rb′ and Rc groups. Preferably, the substituted phenyl groups do not include more than 3 substituents.
Examples of substituted phenyls include, for instance, 4-fluorophenyl, 4-chlorophenyl, 4-bromophenyl, 4-nitrophenyl, 4-methylphenyl, 3-methoxy-phenyl, 3-nitrophenyl, 3-fluorophenyl, 3-chlorophenyl, 3-bromophenyl, 3-thiomethoxyphenyl, 3-methylphenyl, 3-trifluoromethylphenyl, 2-hydroxy-phenyl, 2-methylphenyl, 2-fluorophenyl, 3,4-dichlorophenyl, 3,4-methylene-dioxyphenyl, 3,5-difluorophenyl, 3,5-dichlorophenyl, 2,4-dichlorophenyl, and 2,5-difluorophenyl.
Preferred R1 alkaryl groups include, by way of example, benzyl, 3-phenylethyl, 4-phenyl-n-propyl, and the like.
Preferred R1 alkyl, cycloalkyl and cycloalkenyl groups include, by way of example, sec-butyl, cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclohexyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohex-1-enyl, —CH2-cyclopropyl, —CH2-cyclobutyl, —CH2-cyclohexyl, —CH2-cyclopentyl, —CH2CH2-cyclopropyl, —CH2CH2-cyclobutyl, —CH2CH2-cyclohexyl, —CH2CH2-cyclopentyl, and the like.
Preferred R1 heteroaryls and substituted heteroaryls include, by way of example, pyrid-3-yl, pyrid-4-yl, thiophen-2-yl, thiophen-3-yl, benzothiazol4-yl, 2-phenylbenzoxazol-5-yl, furan-2-yl, benzofuran-2-yl, thionaphthen-2-yl, 2-chlorothiophen-5-yl, 3-methylisoxazol-5-yl, 2-(thiophenyl)thiophen-5-yl, 6-methoxythionaphthen-2-yl, 3-phenyl-1,2,4-thiooxadiazol-5-yl, 2-phenyloxazol-4-yl, and the like.
Preferably R2 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl of from 1 to 4 carbon atoms, alkylalkoxy of from 1 to 4 carbon atoms and alkylthioalkoxy of from 1 to 4 carbon atoms. Particularly preferred R2 substituents include, by way of example, methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, iso-propyl, n-butyl, iso-butyl, —CH2CH2SCH3, and the like.
Preferably, R3 is hydrogen and R3′ is selected from the group consisting of 3-hydroxyphenyl, 3-methoxyphenyl, 3-ethoxycarbonylphenyl, n-hexyl, n-octyl, 4-ethoxycarbonylphenyl, 4-methoxycarbonylphenyl, 3chlorophenyl, 3-cyanophenyl, 3,5-dichlorophenyl, —CH(CH3)φ (R stereoisomer), —CH(CH3)φ (S stereoisomer), phthalid-6-yl, 2-hydroxypyrid-3-yl, 2-(methoxycarbonylmethyl)benzyl, 3-(methoxycarbonyl)benzyl, 2-(2′-methoxycarbonylmethylphenyl)benzyl, and 2-phenylbenzyl.
Particularly preferred compounds for use in the methods and compositions of this invention include, by way of example, the following:
N-(3-hydroxyphenyl)-N′-(phenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide
N-(3-methoxyphenyl)-N′-(phenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide
N-(3-ethoxyphenyl)-N′-(phenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide
N-(4-ethoxycarbonylphenyl) -N′- (phenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide
N-(n-hex yl)-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide
N-(n-octyl)-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide
N-(3-methoxyphenyl)-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alainamide
N-(4-ethoxycarbonylphenyl)-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide
N-(3-ethoxycarbonylphenyl)-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L -alaninamide
N-(3-chlorophenyl )-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)- L-alaninamide
N-(3,5-dichlorophenyl)-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide
N-(3-cyanophenyl)-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide
N-(phthalid-6-yl)-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide
N-[(4-methoxycarbonylphenyl)methyl]-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide
N-(1-cyano-1-phenylmethyl)-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide
N-[(R)-1 -phenylethyl]-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide
N-[(S)-1-phenylethyl]-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide
N-[2-hydroxypyridin-3-yl]-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide
N-[2-methoxycarbonyl-1-phenylethyl]-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide
N-[α-pyridin-2-yl-benyzl]-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide
N-[1 -(N-phthalamido)pent-2-yl]-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide
N-[2-(methoxycarbonylmethyl)benzyl]-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide
N-[3-(methoxycarbonyl)benzyl]-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide
N-[2-(2′-methoxycarbonylmethylphenyl)benzyl]-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide
N-[2-phenylbenzyl]-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide
Still further, this invention provides for novel compounds of formula I above. Preferred compounds are represented by formula II in Table I below:
Figure US06262302-20010717-C00007
II
R1 R2 R3′
—CH3 3-HO-φ-
—CH3 3-CH3O-φ-
—CH3 3-CH3CH2O(CO)-φ-
—CH3 4-CH3CH2O(O)C-φ-
3,5-di-F-φ- —CH3 CH3(CH2)5-
3,5-di-F-φ- —CH3 CH3(CH2)7-
3,5-di-F-φ- —CH3 3-CH3O-φ-
3,5-di-F-φ- —CH3 4-CH3CH2O(O)C-φ-
3,5-di-F-φ- —CH3 3-CHφCH2O(O)C-φ-
3,5-di-F-φ- —CH3 3-Cl-φ-
3,5-di-F-φ- —CH3 3,5-di-Cl-φ-
3,5-di-F-φ- —CH3 3-cyano-φ-
3,5-di-F-φ- —CH3 phthalid-6-yl
3,5-di-F-φ- —CH3 4-CH3O(O)C-φ-CH2
3,5-di-F-φ- —CH3 α-cyanobenzyl
3,5-di-F-φ- —CH3 (R)—CH3(φ)CH—
3,5-di-F-φ- —CH3 (S)—CH3(φ)CH—
3,5-di-F-φ- —CH3 2-hydroxypyridin-3-yl
3,5-di-F-φ- —CH3 α-pyridin-2-yl-benyzl
3,5-di-F-φ- —CH3 1(N-phthalamido)pent-2
-yl
3,5-di-F-φ- —CH3 2-(methoxy-
carbonylmethyl)benzyl
3,5-di-F-φ- —CH3 3-(methoxy-
carbonyl)benzyl
3,5-di-F-φ- —CH3 2-(2′-methoxy-
carbonylmethyl-
phenyl)benzyl
3,5-di-F-φ- —CH3 2-phenylbenzyl
3,5-di-F-φ- —CH3 2-methoxycarbonyl-
1-phenylethyl
DETAILED DESCRIPTION OF THE INVENTION
As above, this invention relates to compounds which inhibit β-amyloid peptide release and/or its synthesis, and, accordingly, have utility in treating Alzheimer's disease. However, prior to describing this invention in further detail, the following terms will first be defined.
Definitions
The term “β-amyloid peptide” refers to a 39-43 amino acid peptide having a molecular weight of about 4.2 kD, which peptide is substantially homologous to the form of the protein described by Glenner, et al.1 including mutations and post-translational modifications of the normal β-amyloid peptide. In whatever form, the β-amyloid peptide is an approximately 39-43 amino acid fragment of a large membrane-spanning glycoprotein, referred to as the β-amyloid precursor protein (APP). Its 43-amino acid sequence is:
1 (SEQ ID NO: 1)
Asp Ala Glu Phe Arg His Asp Ser Gly Tyr
11
Glu Val His His Gln Lys Leu Val Phe Phe
21
Ala Glu Asp Val Gly Ser Asn Lys Gly Ala
31
Ile Ile Gly Leu Met Val Gly Gly Val Val
41
Ile Ala Thr
or a sequence which is substantially homologous thereto.
“Alkyl” refers to monovalent alkyl groups preferably having from 1 to 20 carbon atoms, preferably 1 to 10 carbon atoms, and more preferably 1 to 6 carbon atoms. This term is exemplified by groups such as methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, iso-propyl, n-butyl, iso-butyl, n-hexyl, and the like.
“Substituted alkyl” refers to an alkyl group, preferably of from 1 to 10 carbon atoms, having from 1 to 3 substituents selected from the group consisting of alkoxy, substituted alkoxy, acyl, acyloxy, acylamino, amino, aminoacyl, aminocarboxy esters, cyano, cycloalkyl, halogen, hydroxyl, carboxyl, carboxyl esters, thiol, thioalkoxy, substituted thioalkoxy, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclic, nitro, and mono- and di-alkylamino, mono- and di-(substituted alkyl)amino, mono- and di-arylamino, mono- and di-heteroarylamino, mono- and di-heterocyclic amino, and unsymmetric di-substituted amines having different substituents selected from alkyl, substituted alkyl, aryl, heteroaryl and heterocyclic.
“Alkylene” refers to divalent alkylene groups preferably having from 1 to 10 carbon atoms and more preferably 1 to 6-carbon atoms which can be straight chain or branched. This term is exemplified by groups such as methylene (—CH2—), ethylene (—CH2CH2—), the propylene isomers (e.g., —CH2CH2CH2— and —CH(CH3)CH2—) and the like.
“Alkaryl” refers to -alkylene-aryl groups preferably having from 1 to 10 carbon atoms in the alkylene moiety and from 6 to 14 carbon atoms in the aryl moiety. Such alkaryl groups are exemplified by benzyl, phenethyl, and the like.
“Alkcycloalkyl” refers to -alkylene-cycloalkyl groups preferably having from 1 to 10 carbon atoms in the alkylene moiety and from 3 to 8 carbon atoms in the cycloalkyl moiety. Such alkcycloalkyl groups are exemplified by —CH2-cyclopropyl, —CH2CH2-cyclohexyl, and the like.
“Alkoxy” refers to the group “alkyl-O—”. Preferred alkoxy groups include, by way of example, methoxy, ethoxy, n-propoxy, iso-propoxy, n-butoxy, tert-butoxy, sec-butoxy, n-pentoxy, n-hexoxy, 1,2-dimethylbutoxy, and the like.
“Substituted alkoxy” refers to the group “substituted alkyl-O—” where substituted alkyl is as defined above.
“Alkylalkoxy” refers to the group “-alkylene-O-alkyl” which includes by way of example, methylenemethoxy (—CH2OCH3), ethylenemethoxy (—CH2CH2OCH3), methylene-iso-propoxy (—CH2O—CH(CH3)2) and the like.
“Alkylthioalkoxy” refers to the group “-alkylene-S-alkyl” which includes by way of example, methylenethiomethoxy (—CH2SCH3), ethylenethiomethoxy (—CH2CH2SCH3), methylene-iso-thiopropoxy (—CH2SCH(CH3)2) and the like.
“Alkenyl” refers to alkenyl groups preferably having from 2 to 10 carbon atoms and more preferably 2 to 6 carbon atoms and having at least 1 and preferably from 1-2 sites of alkenyl unsaturation. Preferred alkenyl groups include ethenyl (—CH═CH2), n-propenyl (—CH2CH═CH2), iso-propenyl (—C(CH3)═CH2), and the like.
“Alkynyl” refers to alkynyl groups preferably having from 2 to 10 carbon atoms and more preferably 2 to 6 carbon atoms and having at least 1 and preferably from 1-2 sites of alkynyl unsaturation. Preferred alkynyl groups include ethynyl (—CH≡CH2), propargyl (—CH2CH≡CH2), and the like.
“Acyl” refers to the groups alkyl-C(O)—, substituted alkyl-C(O)—, cycloalkyl-C(O)—, aryl-C(O)—, heteroaryl-C(O)—, and heterocyclic-C(O)— where alkyl, substituted alkyl, cycloalkyl, aryl and heteroaryl are as defined herein.
“Acylamino” refers to the group —C(O)NRR where each R is independently hydrogen or alkyl.
“Aminoacyl” refers to the group —NRC(O)R where each R is independently hydrogen or alkyl.
“Acyloxy” refers to the groups alkyl-C(O)O—, substituted alkyl-C(O)O—, cycloalkyl-C(O)O—, aryl-C(O)O—, heteroaryl-C(O)O—, and heterocyclic-C(O)O— where alkyl, substituted alkyl, cycloalkyl, aryl, heteroaryl and heterocyclic are as defined herein.
“Aryl” refers to an unsaturated aromatic carbocyclic group of from 6 to 14 carbon atoms having a single ring (e.g., phenyl) or multiple condensed rings (e.g., naphthyl or anthryl). Preferred aryls include phenyl, naphthyl and the like.
Unless otherwise constrained by the definition for the individual substituent, such aryl groups can optionally be substituted with from 1 to 3 substituents selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, acyl, acyloxy, alkyl, alkoxy, alkenyl, alkynyl, amino, aminoacyl, aryl, aryloxy, carboxyl, carboxyl esters, amino carboxyl esters, cyano, halo, nitro, heteroaryl, heterocyclic, thioalkoxy, trihalomethyl and the like. Preferred substituents include alkyl, alkoxy, halo, cyano, nitro, trihalomethyl, and thioalkoxy.
“Aryloxy” refers to the group aryl-O— wherein the aryl group is as defined above including optionally substituted aryl groups as also defined above.
“Carboxyl” refers to the group —C(O)OH; “carboxyl esters” refer to the groups —C(O)O-alkyl, —C(O)O-substituted alkyl, —C(O)O-aryl, —C(O)O-heteroaryl, and —C(O)O-heterocyclic; and “aminocarboxyl esters” refer to the groups —NHC(O)OR where R is alkyl, substituted alkyl, aryl, cycloalkyl, heteroaryl, or heterocyclic.
“Cycloalkyl” refers to cyclic alkyl groups of from 3 to 10 carbon atoms having a single cyclic ring or multiple condensed rings which can be optionally substituted with from 1 to 3 alkyl groups. Such cycloalkyl groups include, by way of example, single ring structures such as cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclooctyl, 1-methylcyclopropyl, 2-methylcyclopentyl, 2-methylcyclooctyl, and the like, or multiple ring structures such as adamantanyl, and the like.
“Cycloalkenyl” refers to cyclic alkenyl groups of from 4 to 10 carbon atoms having a single cyclic ring and at least one point of internal unsaturation which can be optionally substituted with from 1 to 3 alkyl groups. Examples of suitable cycloalkenyl groups include, for instance, cyclobut-2-enyl, cyclopent-3-enyl, cyclooct-3-enyl and the like.
“Halo” or “halogen” refers to fluoro, chloro, bromo and iodo and preferably is either fluoro or chloro.
“Heteroaryl” refers to a monovalent aromatic carbocyclic group of from 1 to 10 carbon atoms and 1 to 4 heteroatoms selected from oxygen, nitrogen and sulfur within the ring.
Unless otherwise constrained by the definition for the individual substituent, such heteroaryl groups can be optionally substituted with 1 to 3 substituents selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, aryl, aryloxy, halo, nitro, heteroaryl, hydroxy, thioalkoxy, thioaryloxy and the like. Such heteroaryl groups can have a single ring (e.g., pyridyl or furyl) or multiple condensed rings (e.g., indolizinyl or benzothienyl). Preferred heteroaryls include pyridyl, pyrrolyl and furyl.
“Heteroaryloxy” refers to the group heteroaryl-O— where heteroaryl is as defined above including optionally substituted heteroaryl groups as also defined above.
“Heterocycle” or “heterocyclic” refers to a monovalent saturated or unsaturated group having a single ring or multiple condensed rings, from 1 to 10 carbon atoms and from 1 to 4 hetero atoms selected from nitrogen, sulfur or oxygen within the ring.
Unless otherwise constrained by the definition for the heterocyclic substituent, such heterocyclic groups can be optionally substituted with 1 to 3 substituents selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, aryl, aryloxy, halo, nitro, heteroaryl, thioalkoxy, thioaryloxy and the like. Such heterocyclic groups can have a single ring (e.g., piperidinyl or tetrahydrofuranyl) or multiple condensed rings.
Examples of heterocycles and heteroaryls include, but are not limited to, pyrrole, imidazole, pyrazole, pyridine, pyrazine, pyrimidine, pyridazine, indolizine, isoindole, indole, indazole, purine, quinolizine, isoquinoline, quinoline, phthalazine, naphthylpyridine, quinoxaline, quinazoline, cinnoline, pteridine, carbazole, carboline, phenanthridine, acridine, phenanthroline, isothiazole, phenazine, isoxazole, phenoxazine, phenothiazine, imidazolidine, imidazoline, piperidine, piperazine, indoline, phthalimide, 1,2,3,4-tetrahydroisoquinoline, 4,5,6,7-tetrahydrobenzo[b]thiophene, thiazole, thiazolidine, thiophene, benzo[b]thiophene, morpholino, piperidinyl, pyrrolidine, tetrahydrofuranyl, and the like.
“Heterocyclyloxy” refers to the group heterocyclic-O— where heterocyclic is as defined above including optionally substituted heterocyclic groups as also defined above.
“Thiol” refers to the group —SH.
“Thioalkoxy” refers to the groups —S-alkyl wherein alkyl is as defined above.
“Thio-substituted alkoxy” refers to the groups —S-substituted alkoxy wherein substituted alkoxy is as defined above.
“Thioaryloxy” refers to the group aryl-S— wherein the aryl group is as defined above including optionally substituted aryl groups as also defined above.
“Thioheteroaryloxy” refers to the group heteroaryl-S— wherein the heteroaryl group is as defined above including optionally substituted aryl groups as also defined above.
“Pharmaceutically acceptable salt” refers to pharmaceutically acceptable salts of a compound of Formula I which salts are derived from a variety of organic and inorganic counter ions well known in the art and include, by way of example only, sodium, potassium, calcium, magnesium, ammonium, tetraalkylammonium, and the like; and when the molecule contains a basic functionality, salts of organic or inorganic acids, such as hydrochloride, hydrobromide, tartrate, mesylate, acetate, maleate, oxalate and the like.
Compound Preparation
The compounds of formula I are readily prepared via several divergent synthetic routes with the particular route selected relative to the ease of compound preparation, commercial availability of starting materials, etc.
A first synthetic method involves conventional coupling of an acid derivative with a primary amine of an esterified amino acid as shown in reaction (1) below:
Figure US06262302-20010717-C00008
wherein R1, R2, X′ and X″ are as defined above, and R′ is preferably hydrogen or an alkyl group.
Reaction (1) merely involves coupling of a suitable acid derivative 1 with the primary amine of amino acid/amino acid ester 2 under conditions which provide for the N-acetyl derivative 3. This reaction is conventionally conducted for peptide synthesis and synthetic methods used therein can also be employed to prepare the N-acetyl amino acid/amino acid esters 3. For example, well known coupling reagents such as carbodiimides with or without the use of well known additives such as N-hydroxysuccinimide, 1-hydroxybenzotriazole, etc. can be used to facilitate coupling. The reaction is conventionally conducted in an inert aprotic diluent such as dimethylformamide, dichloromethane, chloroform, acetonitrile, tetrahydrofuran and the like.
Alternatively, in a preferred embodiment, the acid halide of compound 1 can be employed in reaction (1) and, when so employed, it is typically employed in the presence of a suitable base to scavenge the acid generated during the reaction. Suitable bases include, by way of example, triethylamine, diisopropylethylamine, N-methylmorpholine and the like.
Reaction (1) is preferably conducted at from about 0° C. to about 60° C. until reaction completion which typically occurs within 1 to about 24 hours. Upon reaction completion, N-acetyl amino acid/amino acid ester 3 is recovered by conventional methods including precipitation, chromatography, filtration and the like or, alternatively in the case of the ester, is hydrolyzed to the corresponding carboxylic acid without purification and/or isolation other than conventional work-up (e.g., aqueous extraction, etc.).
If an N-acetyl amino acid ester is formed, it is typically converted to the corresponding acid prior to coupling with an amine HNR3R3′. Coupling is accomplished using well known peptide coupling chemistry with well known coupling reagents such as carbodiimides with or without the use of well known additives such as N-hydroxysuccinimide, 1-hydroxybenzotriazole, etc. which can be used to facilitate coupling. The reaction is conventionally conducted in an inert aprotic polar diluent such as dimethylformamide, dichloromethane, chloroform, acetonitrile, tetrahydrofuran and the like. Alternatively, the ester group of 3 can, in some cases, be converted directly into an amide group via conventional ester/amide exchange reactions which are well known in the art.
In reaction (1), each of the reagents (acetic acid derivative 1 and amino acid/amino acid ester 2) are well known in the art with a plurality of each being commercially available.
Alternatively, the compounds of formula I can be prepared by first forming the amino acid amide then N′-acetylating these esters. That is to say that the amine HNR3R3′ is coupled to the N′-blocked amino acid BlockNHCHR2COOH via conventional coupling conditions to provide for the N′-blocked amino acid amide BlockNHCHR2C(O)NR3R3′. The blocking group is then removed via conventional conditions to provide for the free amine which is then N′-acetylated in the manner described above to provide for the compounds of formula I.
After coupling and N′-acetylation (in whatever order) is complete, the resulting amides can be derivatized via conventional chemistry to provide for derivatives of the synthesized compounds. For example, reactive functionality which is blocked on either R2 and/or R3 groups can be deblocked and then derivatized. For example, a Boc-protected amino group on R2 (e.g., lysine side chain) can be deblocked after synthesis and the amino group acylated or otherwised derivatized.
The compounds described herein can also be prepared by use of polymer supported forms of carbodiimide peptide coupling reagents. A polymer supported form of EDC, for example, has been described (Tetrahedron Letters, 34(48), 7685 (1993))10. Additionally, a new carbodiimide coupling reagent, PEPC, and its corresponding polymer supported forms have been discovered and are very useful for the preparation of the compounds of the present invention.
Polymers suitable for use in making a polymer supported coupling reagent are either commercially available or may be prepared by methods well known to the artisan skilled in the polymer arts. A suitable polymer must possess pendant sidechains bearing moieties reactive with the terminal amine of the carbodiimide. Such reactive moieties include chloro, bromo, iodo and methanesulfonyl. Preferably, the reactive moiety is a chloromethyl group. Additionally, the polymer's backbone must be inert to both the carbodiimide and reaction conditions under which the ultimate polymer bound coupling reagents will be used.
Certain hydroxymethylated resins may be converted into chloromethylated resins useful for the preparation of polymer supported coupling reagents. Examples of these hydroxylated resins include the 4-hydroxymethyl-phenylacetamidomethyl resin (Pam Resin) and 4-benzyloxybenzyl alcohol resin (Wang Resin) available from Advanced Chemtech of Louisville, Ky., USA (see Advanced Chemtech 1993-1994 catalog, page 115). The hydroxymethyl groups of these resins may be converted into the desired chloromethyl groups by any of a number of methods well known to the skilled artisan.
Preferred resins are the chloromethylated styrene/divinylbenzene resins because of their ready commercial availability. As the name suggests, these resins are already chloromethylated and require no chemical modification prior to use. These resins are commercially known as Merrifield's resins and are available from Aldrich Chemical Company of Milwaukee, Wis., USA (see Aldrich 1994-1995 catalog, page 899). Methods for the preparation of PEPC and its polymer supported forms are outlined in the following scheme.
Figure US06262302-20010717-C00009
Such methods are described more fully in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 60/019,790 filed Jun. 14, 1996 which application is incorporated herein by reference in its entirety. Briefly, PEPC is prepared by first reacting ethyl isocyanate with 1-(3-aminopropyl)pyrrolidine. The resulting urea is treated with 4-toluenesulfonyl chloride to provide PEPC. The polymer supported form is prepared by reaction of PEPC with an appropriate resin under standard conditions to give the desired reagent.
The carboxylic acid coupling reactions employing these reagents are performed at about ambient temperature to about 45° C., for from about 3 to 120 hours. Typically, the product may be isolated by washing the reaction with CHCl3 and concentrating the remaining organics under reduced pressure. As discussed supra, isolation of products from reactions where a polymer bound reagent has been used is greatly simplified, requiring only filtration of the reaction mixture and then concentration of the filtrate under reduced pressure.
Still other methods for the preparation of esters are provided in the examples below.
In these synthetic methods, the starting materials can contain a chiral center (e.g., L-alanine) and, when a racemic starting material is employed, the resulting product is a mixture of R,S enatiomers. Alternatively, a chiral isomer of the starting material can be employed and, if the reaction protocol employed does not racernized this starting material, a chiral product is obtained. Such reaction protocols can involve inversion of the chiral center during synthesis.
Accordingly, unless otherwise indicated, the products of this invention are a mixture of R,S enatiomers. Preferably, however, when a chiral product is desired, the chiral product corresponds to the L-amino acid derivative. Alternatively, chiral products can be obtained via purification techniques which separates enatiomers from an R,S mixture to provide for one or the other stereoisomer. Such techniques are well known in the art.
Pharmaceutical Formulations
When employed as pharmaceuticals, the compounds of formula I are usually administered in the form of pharmaceutical compositions. These compounds can be administered by a variety of routes including oral, rectal, transdermal, subcutaneous, intravenous, intramuscular, and intranasal. These compounds are effective as both injectable and oral compositions. Such compositions are prepared in a manner well known in the pharmaceutical art and comprise at least one active compound.
This invention also includes pharmaceutical compositions which contain, as the active ingredient, one or more of the compounds of formula I above associated with pharmaceutically acceptable carriers. In making the compositions of this invention, the active ingredient is usually mixed with an excipient, diluted by an excipient or enclosed within such a carrier which can be in the form of a capsule, sachet, paper or other container. When the excipient serves as a diluent, it can be a solid, semi-solid, or liquid material, which acts as a vehicle, carrier or medium for the active ingredient. Thus, the compositions can be in the form of tablets, pills, powders, lozenges, sachets, cachets, elixirs, suspensions, emulsions, solutions, syrups, aerosols (as a solid or in a liquid medium), ointments containing, for example, up to 10% by weight of the active compound, soft and hard gelatin capsules, suppositories, sterile injectable solutions, and sterile packaged powders.
In preparing a formulation, it may be necessary to mill the active compound to provide the appropriate particle size prior to combining with the other ingredients. If the active compound is substantially insoluble, it ordinarily is milled to a particle size of less than 200 mesh. If the active compound is substantially water soluble, the particle size is normally adjusted by milling to provide a substantially uniform distribution in the formulation, e.g., about 40 mesh.
Some examples of suitable excipients include lactose, dextrose, sucrose, sorbitol, mannitol, starches, gum acacia, calcium phosphate, alginates, tragacanth, gelatin, calcium silicate, microcrystalline cellulose, polyvinylpyrrolidone, cellulose, sterile water, syrup, and methyl cellulose. The formulations can additionally include: lubricating agents such as talc, magnesium stearate, and mineral oil; wetting agents; emulsifying and suspending agents; preserving agents such as methyl- and propylhydroxy-benzoates; sweetening agents; and flavoring agents. The compositions of the invention can be formulated so as to provide quick, sustained or delayed release of the active ingredient after administration to the patient by employing procedures known in the art.
The compositions are preferably formulated in a unit dosage form, each dosage containing from about 5 to about 100 mg, more usually about 10 to about 30 mg, of the active ingredient. The term “unit dosage forms” refers to physically discrete units suitable as unitary dosages for human subjects and other mammals, each unit containing a predetermined quantity of active material calculated to produce the desired therapeutic effect, in association with a suitable pharmaceutical excipient. Preferably, the compound of formula I above is employed at no more than about 20 weight percent of the pharmaceutical composition, more preferably no more than about 15 weight percent, with the balance being pharmaceutically inert carrier(s).
The active compound is effective over a wide dosage range and is generally administered in a pharmaceutically effective amount. It will be understood, however, that the amount of the compound actually administered will be determined by a physician, in the light of the relevant circumstances, including the condition to be treated, the chosen route of administration, the actual compound administered, the age, weight, and response of the individual patient, the severity of the patient's symptoms, and the like.
For preparing solid compositions such as tablets, the principal active ingredient is mixed with a pharmaceutical excipient to form a solid preformulation composition containing a homogeneous mixture of a compound of the present invention. When referring to these preformulation compositions as homogeneous, it is meant that the active ingredient is dispersed evenly throughout the composition so that the composition may be readily subdivided into equally effective unit dosage forms such as tablets, pills and capsules. This solid preformulation is then subdivided into unit dosage forms of the type described above containing from, for example, 0.1 to about 500 mg of the active ingredient of the present invention.
The tablets or pills of the present invention may be coated or otherwise compounded to provide a dosage form affording the advantage of prolonged action. For example, the tablet or pill can comprise an inner dosage and an outer dosage component, the latter being in the form of an envelope over the former. The two components can be separated by an enteric layer which serves to resist disintegration in the stomach and permit the inner component to pass intact into the duodenum or to be delayed in release. A variety of materials can be used for such enteric layers or coatings, such materials including a number of polymeric acids and mixtures of polymeric acids with such materials as shellac, cetyl alcohol, and cellulose acetate.
The liquid forms in which the novel compositions of the present invention may be incorporated for administration orally or by injection include aqueous solutions, suitably flavored syrups, aqueous or oil suspensions, and flavored emulsions with edible oils such as cottonseed oil, sesame oil, coconut oil, or peanut oil, as well as elixirs and similar pharmaceutical vehicles.
Compositions for inhalation or insufflation include solutions and suspensions in pharmaceutically acceptable, aqueous or organic solvents, or mixtures thereof, and powders. The liquid or solid compositions may contain suitable pharmaceutically acceptable excipients as described supra. Preferably the compositions are administered by the oral or nasal respiratory route for local or systemic effect. Compositions in preferably pharmaceutically acceptable solvents may be nebulized by use of inert gases. Nebulized solutions may be inhaled directly from the nebulizing device or the nebulizing device may be attached to a face masks tent, or intermittent positive pressure breathing machine. Solution, suspension, or powder compositions may be administered, preferably orally or nasally, from devices which deliver the formulation in an appropriate manner.
The following formulation examples illustrate the pharmaceutical compositions of the present invention.
Formulation Example 1
Hard gelatin capsules containing the following ingredients are prepared:
Quantity
Ingredient (mg/capsule)
Active Ingredient 30.0
Starch 305.0
Magnesium stearate 5.0
The above ingredients are mixed and filled into hard gelatin capsules in 340 mg quantities.
Formulation Example 2
A tablet formula is prepared using the ingredients below:
Quantity
Ingredient (mg/tablet)
Active Ingredient 25.0
Cellulose, microcrystalline 200.0
Colloidal silicon dioxide 10.0
Stearic acid 5.0
The components are blended and compressed to form tablets, each weighing 240 mg.
Formulation Example 3
A dry powder inhaler formulation is prepared containing the following components:
Ingredient Weight %
Active Ingredient 5
Lactose 95
The active mixture is mixed with the lactose and the mixture is added to a dry powder inhaling appliance.
Formulation Example 4
Tablets, each containing 30 mg of active ingredient, are prepared as follows:
Quantity
Ingredient (mg/tablet)
Active Ingredient 30.0 mg
Starch 45.0 mg
Microcrystalline cellulose 35.0 mg
Polyvinylpyrrolidone 4.0 mg
(as 10% solution in sterile water)
Sodium carboxymethyl starch 4.5 mg
Magnesium stearate 0.5 mg
Talc 1.0 mg
Total 120 mg
The active ingredient, starch and cellulose are passed through a No. 20 mesh U.S. sieve and mixed thoroughly. The solution of polyvinylpyrrolidone is mixed with the resultant powders, which are then passed through a 16 mesh U.S. sieve. The granules so produced are dried at 50° to 60° C. and passed through a 16 mesh U.S. sieve. The sodium carboxymethyl starch, magnesium stearate, and talc, previously passed through a No. 30 mesh U.S. sieve, are then added to the granules which, after mixing, are compressed on a tablet machine to yield tablets each weighing 150 mg.
Formulation Example 5
Capsules, each containing 40 mg of medicament are made as follows:
Quantity
Ingredient (mg/capsule)
Active Ingredient 40.0 mg
Starch 109.0 mg
Magnesium stearate 1.0 mg
Total 150.0 mg
The active ingredient, cellulose, starch, an magnesium stearate are blended, passed through a No. 20 mesh U.S. sieve, and filled into hard gelatin capsules in 150 mg quantities.
Formulation Example 6
Suppositories, each containing 25 mg of active ingredient are made as follows:
Ingredient Amount
Active Ingredient 25 mg
Saturated fatty acid glycerides to 2,000 mg
The active ingredient is passed through a No. 60 mesh U.S. sieve and suspended in the saturated fatty acid glycerides previously melted using the minimum heat necessary. The mixture is then poured into a suppository mold of nominal 2.0 g capacity and allowed to cool.
Formulation Example 7
Suspensions, each containing 50 mg of medicament per 5.0 ml dose are made as follows:
Ingredient Amount
Active Ingredient 50.0 mg
Xanthan gum 4.0 mg
Sodium carboxymethyl cellulose (11%) 50.0 mg
Microcrystalline cellulose (89%)
Sucrose 1.75 g
Sodium benzoate 10.0 mg
Flavor and Color q.v.
Purified water to 5.0 ml
The medicament, sucrose and xanthan gum are blended, passed through a No. 10 mesh U.S. sieve, and then mixed with a previously made solution of the microcrystalline cellulose and sodium carboxymethyl cellulose in water. The sodium benzoate, flavor, and color are diluted with some of the water and added with stirring. Sufficient water is then added to produce the required volume.
Formulation Example 8
Quantity
Ingredient (mg/capsule)
Active Ingredient 15.0 mg
Starch 407.0 mg
Magnesium stearate 3.0 mg
Total 425.0 mg
The active ingredient, cellulose, starch, and magnesium stearate are blended, passed through a No. 20 mesh U.S. sieve, and filled into hard gelatin capsules in 560 mg quantities.
Formulation Example 9
A subcutaneous formulation may be prepared as follows:
Ingredient Quantity
Active Ingredient 5.0 mg
corn oil 1 ml
Formulation Example 10
A topical formulation may be prepared as follows:
Ingredient Quantity
Active Ingredient 1-10 g
Emulsifying Wax 30 g
Liquid Paraffin 20 g
White Soft Paraffin to 100 g
The white soft paraffin is heated until molten. The liquid paraffin and emulsifying wax are incorporated and stirred until dissolved. The active ingredient is added and stirring is continued until dispersed. The mixture is then cooled until solid.
Another preferred formulation employed in the methods of the present invention employs transdermal delivery devices (“patches”). Such transdermal patches may be used to provide continuous or discontinuous infusion of the compounds of the present invention in controlled amounts. The construction and use of transdermal patches for the delivery of pharmaceutical agents is well known in the art. See. e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 5,023,252, issued Jun. 11, 1991, herein incorporated by reference. Such patches may be constructed for continuous, pulsatile, or on demand delivery of pharmaceutical agents.
Frequently, it will be desirable or necessary to introduce the pharmaceutical composition to the brain, either directly or indirectly. Direct techniques usually involve placement of a drug delivery catheter into the host's ventricular system to bypass the blood-brain barrier. One such implantable delivery system used for the transport of biological factors to specific anatomical regions of the body is described in U.S. Pat. No. 5,011,472 which is herein incorporated by reference.
Indirect techniques, which are generally preferred, usually involve formulating the compositions to provide for drug latentiation by the conversion of hydrophilic drugs into lipid-soluble drugs. Latentiation is generally achieved through blocking of the hydroxy, carbonyl, sulfate, and primary amine groups present on the drug to render the drug more lipid soluble and amenable to transportation across the blood-brain barrier. Alternatively, the delivery of hydrophilic drugs may be enhanced by intra-arterial infusion of hypertonic solutions which can transiently open the blood-brain barrier.
Other suitable formulations for use in the present invention can be found in Remington's Pharmaceutical Sciences, Mace Publishing Company, Philadelphia, Pa., 17th ed. (1985).
Utility
The compounds and pharmaceutical compositions of the invention are useful in inhibiting, β-amyloid peptide release and/or its synthesis, and, accordingly, have utility in treating Alzheimer's disease in mammals including humans.
As noted above, the compounds described herein are suitable for use in a variety of drug delivery systems described above. Additionally, in order to enhance the in vivo serum half-life of the administered compound, the compounds may be encapsulated, introduced into the lumen of liposomes, prepared as a colloid, or other conventional techniques may be employed which provide an extended serum half-life of the compounds. A variety of methods are available for preparing liposomes, as described in, e.g., Szoka, et al., U.S. Pat. Nos. 4,235,871, 4,501,728 and 4,837,028 each of which is incorporated herein by reference.
The amount of compound administered to the patient will vary depending upon what is being administered, the purpose of the administration, such as prophylaxis or therapy, the state of the patient, the manner of administration, and the like. In therapeutic applications, compositions, are administered to a patient already suffering from AD in an amount sufficient to at least partially arrest further onset of the symptoms of the disease and its complications. An amount adequate to accomplish this is defined as “therapeutically effective dose.” Amounts effective for this use will depend on the judgment of the attending clinician depending upon factors such as the degree or severity of AD in the patient, the age, weight and general condition of the patient, and the like.
Preferably, for use as therapeutics, the compounds described herein are administered at dosages ranging from about 1 to about 500 mg/kg/day.
In prophylactic applications, compositions are administered to a patient at risk of developing AD (determined for example by genetic screening or familial trait) in an amount sufficient to inhibit the onset of symptoms of the disease. An amount adequate to accomplish this is defined as “prophylactically effective dose.” Amounts effective for this use will depend on the judgment of the attending clinician depending upon factors such as the age, weight and general condition of the patient, and the like. Preferably, for use as prophylactics, the compounds described herein are administered at dosages ranging from about 1 to about 500 mg/kg/day.
As noted above, the compounds administered to a patient are in the form of pharmaceutical compositions described above. These compositions may be sterilized by conventional sterilization techniques, or may be sterile filtered. The resulting aqueous solutions may be packaged for use as is, or lyophilized, the lyophilized preparation being combined with a sterile aqueous carrier prior to administration. The pH of the compound preparations typically will be between 3 and 11, more preferably from 5 to 9 and most preferably from 7 and 8. It will be understood that use of certain of the foregoing excipients, carriers, or stabilizers will result in the formation of pharmaceutical salts.
The following synthetic and biological examples are offered to illustrate this invention and are not to be construed in any way as limiting the scope of this invention. Unless otherwise stated, all temperatures are in degrees Celsius.
EXAMPLES
In the examples below, the following abbreviations have the following meanings. If an abbreviation is not defined, it has its generally accepted meaning.
aq. = aqueous
Boc = tert-butoxycarbonyl
BOP = benzotriazol-1-yloxy-tris(dimethylamino)phosphonium
hexafluorophosphate
bd = broad doublet
bs = broad singlet
c = concentration (g/mL)
cc = cubic centimeter
CDI = 1,1′-carbonyldiimidazole
d = doublet
dd = doublet of doublets
DMAP = dimethylaminopyridine
DMF = dimethylformamide
DMSO = dimethylsulfoxide
EDC = 1-(3-dimethylamiopropyl)-3-ethylcarbodiimide
hydrochloride
EDTA = ethylene diamine tetraacetic acid
eq. = equivalents
EtOAc = ethyl acetate
EtOH = ethanol
g = grams
h = hour
L = liter
m = multiplet
M % = mole percent
max = maximum
MeOH = methanol
meq = milliequivalent
mg = milligram
mL = milliliter
mm = millimeter
mM = millimolar
mmol = millimole
mp = melting point
N = normal
ng = nanogram
nm = nanometers
OD = optical density
PEPC = 1-(3-(1-pyrrolidinyl)propyl)-3-ethylcarbodiimide
pg = picogram
pM = picoMolar
psi = pounds per square inch
q = quartet
quint. = quintet
rpm = rotations per minute
s = singlet
t = triplet
TFA = trifluoroacetic acid
THF = tetrahydrofuran
tlc = thin layer chromatography
μg = picogram
μL = microliter
Uv = ultraviolet
In the examples below, all temperatures are in degrees Celcius (unless otherwise indicated).
The following General Procedures A′-K′, Examples A′-D′ and Examples A1-A81 illustrate the synthesis of various N-(aryl/heteroarylacetyl)amino acid esters which can be hydrolyzed to provide for N-(aryl/heteroarylacetyl)amino acids which are useful as starting materials for the amide compounds of this invention.
GENERAL PROCEDURE A′ Coupling of R1C(X′)(X″)C(O)Cl with HR2NCH(2)C(O)XR3
To a stirred solution of (D,L)-alanine iso-butyl ester hydrochloride (from Example B below) (4.6 mmol) in 5 mL of pyridine was added 4.6 mmol of an acid chloride. Precipitation occurred immediately. The mixture was stirred for 3.5 h, diluted with 100 mL of diethyl ether, washed with 10% HCl three times, brine once, 20% potassium carbonate once and brine once. The solution was dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered, and evaporated at reduced pressure to yield the product. Other amino acid esters may also be employed in this procedure.
GENERAL PROCEDURE B′ Coupling of R1C(X′)(X″)C(O)OH with H2NCH(R2)C(O)XR3
A solution of the acid (3.3 mmol) and CDI in 20 mL THF was stirred for 2 h. L-alanine iso-butyl ester hydrochloride (from Example B below) (3.6 mmol) was added, followed by 1.5 mL (10.8 mmol) of triethylamine. The reaction mixture was stirred overnight. The reaction mixture was diluted with 100 mL of diethyl ether, washed with 10% HCl three times, brine once, 20% potassium carbonate once and brine once. The solution was dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered, and evaporated at reduced pressure to yield the product. Other amino acid esters may also be employed in this procedure.
GENERAL PROCEDURE C′ Esterification of R1C(X′)(X″)C(O)NHCH(R2)C(O)OH With HOR3
To a stirred solution of phenylacetylvaline (1.6470 g, 7.0 mmol) in 20 ml THF was added CDI (1.05 g, 6.5 mmol) and the mixture was stirred for 1.5 h. 2-Methylbutanol (0.53 g, 6 mmol) was added the mixture, followed by addition of NaH (0.16 g, 6.5 mmol). Bubbling occurred immediately. The reaction mixture was stirred overnight. The reaction mixture was diluted with 100 mL of diethyl ether, washed with 10% HCl three times, brine once, 20% potassium carbonate once and brine once. The solution was dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered, and evaporated at reduced pressure to yield the product. Other N-acyl amino acids and alcohols may also be employed in this procedure.
GENERAL PROCEDURE D′ Ester Hydrolysis to the Free Acid
Ester hydrolysis to the free acid was conducted by conventional methods. Below are two examples of such conventional de-esterification methods.
To the ester in a 1:1 mixture of CH3OH/H2O was added 2-5 equivalents of K2CO3. The mixture was heated to about 50° C. for about 0.5 to 1.5 hours until tlc showed complete reaction. The reaction was cooled to room temperature and the methanol was removed at reduced pressure. The pH of the remaining aqueous solution was adjusted to about 2, and ethyl acetate was added to exact the product. The organic phase was then washed with saturated aqueous NaCl and dried over MgSO4. The solution was stripped free of solvent at reduced pressure to yield the product.
The amino acid ester was dissolved in dioxane/water (4:1) to which was added LiOH (˜2 eq.) that was dissolved in water such that the total solvent after addition was about 2:1 dioxane:water. The reaction mixture was stirred until reaction completion and the dioxane was removed under reduced pressure. The residue was diluted with EtOAc, the layers were separated and the aqueous layer acidified to pH 2. The aqueous layer was back extracted with EtOAc, the combined organics were dried over Na2SO4 and the solvent was removed under reduced pressure after filtration. The residue was purified by conventional methods (e.g., recrystallization).
The following exemplifies this later example. The methyl ester of 3-NO2 phenylacetyl alanine 9.27 g (0.0348 mols) was dissolved in 60 mL dioxane and 15 mL of H2O and adding LiOH (3.06 g, 0.0731 mol) that has been dissolved in 15 mL of H2O. After stirring for 4 hours, the dioxane was removed under reduced pressure and the residue diluted with EtOAc, the layers were separated and the aqueous layer acidified to pH 2. The aqueous layer was back extracted with EtOAc (4×100 mL), the combined organics were dried over Na2SO4 and the solvent was removed under reduced pressure after filtration. The residue was recrystallized from EtOAc/isooctane giving 7.5 g (85%) of 3-nitrophenylacetyl alanine. C11H12N2O5 requires C=52.38, H=4.80, and N=11.11. Analysis found C=52.54, H=4.85, and N=11.08. [α]23=−29.9@589 nm.
GENERAL PROCEDURE E′ Low Temperature BOP Coupling of Acid and Alcohol
A solution of methylene chloride containing the carboxylic acid (100M %) and N-methyl morpholine (150 M %) was cooled to −20° C. under nitrogen. BOP (105 M %) was added in one portion and the reaction mixture was maintained at −20° C. for 15 minutes. The corresponding alcohol (120 M %) was added and the reaction mixture was allowed to warm to room temperature and stirred for 12 hours. The reaction mixture was then poured into water and extracted with ethyl acetate (3×). The combined ethyl acetate portions were backwashed with saturated aqueous citric acid (2×), saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate (2×), brine (1×), dried over anhydrous magnesium sulfate or sodium sulfate and the solvent removed under reduced pressure to yield the crude product.
GENERAL PROCEDURE F′ EDC Coupling of Acid and Amine
The acid derivative was dissolved in methylene chloride. The amine (1 eq.), N-methylmorpholine (5 eq.), and hydroxybenzotriazole monohydrate (1.2 eq.) were added in sequence. The reaction was cooled to about 0° C. and then 1.2 eq. of 1-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-3-ethylcarbodiimide hydrochloride was added. The solution was allowed to stir overnight and come to room temperature under N2 pressure. The reaction mix was worked up by washing the solution with saturated, aqueous Na2CO3, 0.1M citric acid, and brine before drying with Na2SO4 and removal of solvents to yield crude product. Pure products were obtained by flash chromatography in an appropriate solvent.
GENERAL PROCEDURE G′ EDC Coupling of Acid and Amine
A round bottom flask was charged with carboxylic acid (1.0 eq.), hydroxy-benzotriazole hydrate (1.1 eq.) and amine (1.0 eq.) in THF under nitrogen atmosphere. An appropriate amount (1.1 eq. for free amines and 2.2 eq. for hydrochloride amine salts) of base, such as Hunig's base was added to the well stirred mixture followed by EDC (1.1 eq.). After stirring from 4 to 17 hours at room temperature the solvent was removed at reduced pressure, the residue taken up in EtOAc (or similar solvent)/water. The organic layer was washed with saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate solution, 1N HCl, brine and dried over anhydrous sodium sulfate. In some cases, the isolated product was analytically pure at this stage while, in other cases, purification via chromatography and/or recrystallization was required prior to biological evaluation.
GENERAL PROCEDURE H′ Coupling of R1C(X′)(X″)C(O)Cl with H2NCH(R2)C(O)XR3
An excess of oxalyl chloride in dichloromethane was added to the acid derivative together with one drop of DMF. The resulting mixture was stirred for about 2 hours or until bubbling ceases. The solvent was then removed under reduced pressure and rediluted with dry methylene chloride. To the resulting solution was added about 1.1 eq. of the appropriate amino acid ester and triethylamine (1.1 eq. in methylene chloride). The system was stirred at room temperature for 2 hours and then the solvent was removed under reduced pressure. The residue was dissolved in ethyl acetate, washed with 1N HCl followed by 1N NaOH. The organic layer was dried over anhydrous soldium sulfate, filtered and the solvent removed under reduced pressure to provide for the desired product.
GENERAL PROCEDURE I′ P-EPC Coupling
P-EPC coupling employs an amino acid ester and a substituted acetic acid compound. The acetic acid derivative is well known in the art and is typically commercially available. The amino acid ester is prepared by conventional methods from the known and typically commercially available N-BOC amino acid as described in GENERAL PROCEDURE J′ below.
Specifically, the appropriate amino ester free base (0.0346 mmols) and substituted phenylacetic acid (0.069 mmols) were dissolved in 2.0 mL CHCl3 (EtOH free), treated with 150 mg of P-EPC (0.87 meq./g) and the reaction was mixed for 4 days at 23° C. The reaction was filtered through a plug of cotton, rinsed with 2.0 mL of CHCl3 and the filtrate evaporated under a stream of nitrogen. The purity of each sample was determined by 1H NMR and ranged from 50% to >95%. Between 8.0 and 15.0 mg of final product was obtained from each reaction and was tested without additional purification.
GENERAL PROCEDURE J′ Synthesis of Amino Acid Esters From the Corresponding N-BOC Amino Acid
A. Esterification of the Acid
The N-BOC amino acid was dissolved in dioxane and treated with an excess of alcohol (˜1.5 eq.) and catalytic DMAP (100 mg) at 0° C. Stirring was continued until reaction completion whereupon the product was recovered by conventional methods.
B. Removal of N-BOC Group
The N-BOC protected amino acid was dissolved in methylene chloride (0.05M) and treated with 10 eq. of TFA at room temperature under a nitrogen atmosphere. The reaction was monitored by tlc until starting material was consumed usually within 1-5 hours. An additional 10 eq. of TFA was added to the reaction if the starting material was still present after 5 hours. The reaction was carefully neutralized with Na2CO3, separated, the organic layer washed with brine and dried over anhydrous Na2SO4. The crude amine was then used without purification.
Specific exemplification of these procedures are as follows:
1. Racemic (+/−)-N-BOC-α-amino butyric acid (Aldrich) (9.29 g, 0.0457 mol) was dissolved in 100 mL of dioxane and treated with iso-butyl alcohol (6.26 mL, 0.0686 mol), EDC (8.72 g, 0.0457) and catalytic DMAP (100 mg) at 0° C. After stirring for 17 hours, the organics were evaporated at reduced pressure, the residue diluted with EtOAc washed with NaCO3, brine and dried over Na2SO4. Evaporation yields 8.42 g (71%) of an oil. C13H25NO4 requires: C=60.21, H=9.72, and N=5.40. Anal found: C=59.91, H=9.89, and N=5.67.
The above N-BOC amino acid ester (8.00 g, 0.032 mol) was deprotected as above giving 3.12 g (61%) of the free base as a colorless oil which solidifies upon standing.
2. L-N-BOC-alanine (Aldrich) (8.97 g, 0.047 mol) was dissolved in 100 mL of CH2Cl2, iso-butyl alcohol (21.9 mL, 0.238 mol) and treated with DMAP (100 mg) and EDC (10.0 g, 0.52 mol) at 0° C. The mixture was stirred for 17 hours, diluted with H2O, washed with 1.0 N HCl, NaHCO3, then brine and the organics were dried over Na2SO4. Filtration and evaporation yields 11.8 g (quantitative) of L-N-BOC alanine iso-butyl ester which is contaminated with a small amount of solvent. A sample was vacuum dried for analytical analysis. C12H23NO4 requires: C=58.79, H=9.38, and N=5.71. Anal found: C=58.73, H=9.55, and N=5.96.
The above N-BOC amino acid ester (11.8 g, 0.0481 mol) was deprotected as above. The free base was converted to the corresponding HCl salt using saturated HCl (g)/EtOAc to give L-N-alanine iso-butyl ester hydrochloride. Obtained 4.2 g (48%) of a colorless solid. C7H15NO2. HCl requires: C=46.28, H=8.88, and N=7.71. Anal found: C=46.01, H=8.85, and N=7.68.
GENERAL PROCEDURE K′ Methyl Ester Formation from Amino Acids
The amino acid (amino acid or amino acid hydrochloride) is suspended in methanol and chilled to 0° C. HCl gas is bubbled through this solution for 5 minutes. The reaction is allowed to warm to room temperature then stirred for 4 hours. The solvents are then removed at reduced pressure to afford the desired amino acid methyl ester hydrochloride. This product is usually used without further purification.
Example A′ Synthesis of free and polymer bound PEPC
N-ethyl-N′-3-(1-pyrrolidinyl)propylurea
To a solution of 27.7 g (0.39 mol) ethyl isocyanate in 250 mL chloroform was added 50 g (0.39 mol) 3-(1-pyrrolidinyl)propylamine dropwise with cooling. Once the addition was complete, the cooling bath was removed and the reaction mixture stirred at room temperature for 4 hours. The reaction mixture was then concentrated under reduced pressure to give 74.5 g (96.4%) of the desired urea as a clear oil.
1-(3-(1-pyrrolidinyl)propyl)-3-ethylcarbodiimide (P-EPC)
To a solution of 31.0 g (0.156 mol) N-ethyl-N′-3-(1-pyrrolidinyl)propyl-urea in 500 mL dichloromethane was added 62.6 g (0.62 mol) triethylamine and the solution was cooled to 0° C. To this solution were then added 59.17 g (0.31 mol) 4-toluenesulfonyl chloride in 400 mL dichloromethane dropwise at such a rate as to maintain the reaction at 0-5° C. After the addition was complete, the reaction mixture was warmed to room temperature and then heated to reflux for 4 hours. After cooling to room temperature, the reaction mixture was washed with saturated aqueous potassium carbonate (3×150 mL). The aqueous phases were combined and extracted with dichloromethane. All organic phases were combined and concentrated under reduced pressure. The resultant orange slurry was suspended in 250 mL diethyl ether and the solution decanted off from the solid. The slurry/decantation process was repeated 3 more times. The ether solutions were combined and concentrated under reduced pressure to give 18.9 g (67%) of the desired product as a crude orange oil. A portion of the oil was distilled under vacuum to give a colorless oil distilling at 78-82° C. (0.4 mm Hg).
Preparation of a polymer supported form of 1-(3-(1-pyrrolidinyl)propyl)-3-ethylcarbodiimide (P-EPC)
A suspension of 8.75 g (48.3 mmol) 1-(3-(1-pyrrolidin-yl)propyl)-3-ethylcarbodiimide and 24.17 g (24.17 mmol) Merrifield's resin (2% cross-linked, 200-400 mesh, chloromethylated styrene/divinylbenzene copolymer, 1 meq. Cl/g) in dimethylformamide was heated at 100° C. for 2 days. The reaction was cooled and filtered and the resulting resin washed sequentially with 1L DMF, 1L THF and 1L diethyl ether. The remaining resin was then dried under vacuum for 18 hours.
Example B′ Preparation of alanine iso-butyl ester hydrochloride
A mixture of 35.64 g (0.4 mol) of (D,L)-alanine (Aldrich) (or L-alanine (Aldrich)); 44 mL (0.6 mol) of thionyl chloride (Aldrich) and 200 mL of isobutanol was refluxed for 1.5 hours and the volatiles were removed completely on a rotavapor of 90° C. under reduced pressure to give (D,L)-alanine iso-butyl ester hydrochloride (or L-alanine iso-butyl ester hydrochloride), which was pure enough to be used for further transformations.
Example C′ Preparation of 3,5-dichlorophenylacetic acid
To a solution of 3.5 g of 3,5-dichlorobenzyl alcohol (Aldrich) in 75 mL of dichloromethane at 0° C. was added 1.8 mL of methane sulfonylchloride followed by 3.5 mL of triethylamine added dropwise. After 2 hours the solution was diluted to 150 mL with dichloromethane, washed with 3N HCl, saturated aqueous NaHCO3 dried with Na2SO4 and the solvents removed to yield the desired 3,5-dichlorobenzyl methanesulfonate as a yellow oil that was used without purification.
The crude sulfonate was dissolved in 50 mL of DMF at 0° C. and then 3 g of KCN was added. After 2 hours an additional 50 mL of DMF was added and the solution was stirred for 16 hours. The red solution was diluted with 1 L of H2O and acidified to pH 3 with 3N HCl. The aqueous solution was extracted with dichloromethane. The combined organics were washed with 3N HCl, dried with Na2SO4 and the solvents removed at reduced pressure to yield crude 3,5-dichlorophenylacetonitrile which was used without purification.
The nitrile was added to a mixture of 40 mL of concentrated sulfuric acid and 50 mL H2O and heated to reflux for 48 hours, cooled to room temperature and stirred for 48 hours. The reaction was diluted into 1 L of crushed ice, warmed to toom temperature and extracted with 2×200 mL of dichloromethane and 2×200 mL of ethylacetate. Both sets of organics were combined and washed with saturated aqueous NaHCO3. The NaHCO3 fractions were combined and acidified to pH 1 with 3N HCl. The white solid was too fine to filter and was extracted out with 2×200 mL of dichloromethane. The combined organics were dried with Na2SO4 and the solvents removed at reduced pressure to yield crude 3,5-dichlorophenylacetic acid as a white solid. The solid was slurried with hexane and filtered to get 1.75 g of white solid.
NMR (CDCl3): (in ppm) 3.61 (s, 2H), 7.19 (s,1H), 7.30 (s, 1H)
Example D′ Synthesis of N-(3-chlorophenylacetyl)alanine
The title compound was prepared using L-alanine (Nova Biochem) and 3-chlorophenyl acetic acid (Aldrich) by following General Procedures F′ or G′, followed by hydrolysis using General Procedure D′.
Example A1 Synthesis of N-(phenylacetyl)-D,L-alanine iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure A′ above and using phenylacetyl chloride (Aldrich) and D,L-alanine iso-butyl ester hydrochloride (from Example B′ above), the title compound was prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by extraction with Et2O followed by washes with aqueous K2CO3 and aqueous HCl.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=7.23-7.36 (m, 5H), 6.18 (d, 1H), 4.58 (t, J=7.3 Hz, 1H), 3.87 (m, 2H), 3.57 (s, 2H), 1.90 (m, 1H), 1.34 (d, J=7.2 Hz, 3H), 0.89 (d, J=6.8 Hz, 6H).
13C-nmr (CDCl3): δ=172.7, 170.3, 134.5, 129.2, 128.8, 127.2, 71.3, 48.1, 43.4, 27.5, 18.8, 18.3.
C15H21NO3 (MW=263.34; Mass Spectroscopy (MH+=264))
Example A2 Synthesis of N-(3-phenylpropionyl)-D,L-alanine iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure A′ above and using 3-phenylpropionyl chloride (Aldrich) and D,L-alanine iso-butyl ester hydrochloride (from Example B′ above), the title compound was prepared as a solid having a melting point of from 51°-54° C. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by extraction with Et2O followed by washes with aqueous K2CO3 and aqueous HCl.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=7.25 (m, 2H), 7.19 (m, 3H), 6.28 (d, J=7.2 Hz, 1H), 4.58 (quint., J=7.2 Hz, 1H), 3.89 (m, 2H), 2.95 (t, J=7.7 Hz, 2H), 2.50 (m, 2H), 1.92 (m, 1H), 1.33 (d, J=7.1 Hz, 3H), 0.91 (d, J=6.7 Hz, 6H).
13C-nmr (CDCl3): δ=173.0, 171.5, 140.6, 128.3, 128.1, 126.0, 71.2, 47.8, 37.9, 31.4, 27.5, 18.79, 18.77, 18.3.
C16H23NO3 (MW=277.37, Mass Spectroscopy (MH+ 278))
Example A3 Synthesis of N-(3-methylpentanoyl)-L-alanine iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure B′ and using 3-methylpentanoic acid (Aldrich) and L-alanine iso-butyl ester hydrochloride (from Example B′ above), the title compound was prepared as an oil. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by extraction with Et2O followed by washes with aqueous K2CO3 and aqueous HCl.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=6.08 (d, J=5.9 Hz, 1H), 4.62 (quint., J=7.3 Hz, 1H), 3.92 (m, 2H), 2.22 (m, 1H), 1.84-2.00 (m, 3H), 1.40 (d, J=7.2 Hz, 3H), 1.35 (m, 1H), 1.20 (m, 1H), 0.85-0.96 (m, 12H).
13C-nmr (CDCl3): δ=173.3, 172.1, 71.4, 47.9, 43.9, 32.3, 29.38, 29.35, 27.6, 19.10, 19.06, 18.93, 18.91, 18.72, 18.67, 11.3.
C13H25NO3 (MW=243.35, Mass Spectroscopy (MH+ 244))
Example A4 Synthesis of N-[(4-chlorophenyl)acetyl]-L-alanine iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure B′ and using 4-chlorophenylacetic acid (Aldrich) and L-alanine iso-butyl ester hydrochloride (from Example B′ above), the title compound was prepared as a solid having a melting point of 111°-113° C. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by extraction with Et2O followed by washes with aqueous K2CO3 and aqueous HCl.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=7.30 (d, J=8.2 Hz, 2H), 7.21 (d, J=8.3 Hz, 2H), 6.18 (d, J=5.5 Hz, 1H), 4.57 (quint., J=7.2 Hz, 1H), 3.88 (m, 2H), 3.53 (s, 2H), 1.91 (m, 1H), 1.36 (d, J=7.1 Hz, 3H), 0.90 (d, J=6.8 Hz, 6H).
13C-nmr (CDCl3): δ=172.8, 169.8, 133.1, 133.0, 130.6, 128.9, 71.4, 48.2, 42.6, 27.6, 18.85, 18.82, 18.4.
C15H20NO3Cl (MW=297.78, Mass Spectroscopy (MH+ 298))
Example A5 Synthesis of N-[(3,4dichlorophenyl)acetyl]-L-alanine iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure B′ and using 3,4dichlorophenylacetic acid (Aldrich) and L-alanine iso-butyl ester hydrochloride (from Example B′ above), the title compound was prepared as a solid having a melting point of 81°-83° C. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by extraction with Et2O followed by washes with aqueous K2CO3 and aqueous HCl.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=0.90 (d, J=6.8 Hz, 6H), 1.38 (d, J=7.1 Hz, 3H), 1.91 (m, 1H), 3.50 (s, 2H), 3.90 (m, 2H), 4.57 (quint., J=7.1 Hz, 1H), 6.31 (d, J=4.9 Hz, 1H),7.12 (m, 1H), 7.38 (m, 2H).
13C-nmr (CDCl3): δ=18.4, 18.8, 18.9, 27.6, 42.2, 48.3, 71.5, 128.6, 130.6, 131.2, 131.3, 132.6, 134.7, 169.2, 172.8.
C15H19NO3Cl2 (MW=332.23, Mass Spectroscopy (MH+ 332))
Example A6 Synthesis of N-[(4-methylphenyl)acetyl]-D,L-alanine iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure B′ and using 4-methylphenylacetic acid (Aldrich) and D,L-alanine iso-butyl ester hydrochloride (from Example B′ above), the title compound was prepared as a solid having a melting point of 102°-104° C. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel (Rf=0.6 in 33% ethyl acetate/hexanes) and purification was by extraction with Et2O followed by washes with aqueous K2CO3 and aqueous HCl.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=0.90 (d, J=6.7 Hz, 6H), 1.35 (d, J=7.2 Hz, 3H), 1.91 (m, 1H), 2.34 (s, 3H), 3.55 (s, 2H), 3.88 (m, 2H), 4.58 (m, 1H), 6.05 (bd, 1H), 7.16 (s, 4H).
13C-nmr (CDCl3): δ=18.5, 18.85, 18.87, 21.0, 27.6, 43.1, 48.1, 71.3, 129.2, 129.6, 131.3, 136.9, 170.6, 172.8.
C16H23NO3 (MW=277.37, Mass Spectroscopy (MH+ 278))
Example A7 Synthesis of N-[(3pyridyl)acetyl]-D,L-alanine iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure F′ and using 3-pyridylacetic acid hydrochloride (Aldrich) and D,L-alanine iso-butyl ester hydrochloride (from Example B′ above), the title compound was prepared as a solid having a melting point of 62°-64° C. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel (Rf=0.48 10% methanol/dichloromethane) and purification was by silica gel chromatography.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=8.40 (d, J=2.8, 2H); 7.6 (m, 1H): 7.16 (m, 2H); 4.5 (quint., J=7.2, 7.2, 1H); 3.8 (m, 2H); 3.48 (s, 2H); 1.8 (m, 1H); 1.30 (d, J=7.2, 3H); 0.81 (d, J=6.7, 6H).
13C-nmr (CDCl3): δ=173.4, 170.1, 150.6, 148.8, 137.4, 131.4, 124.1, 71.9, 48.9, 40.6, 28.1, 19.5, 19.4, 18.6.
C14H20N2O3 (MW=264, Mass Spectroscopy (MH+ 265))
Example A8 Synthesis of N-[(1-naphthyl)acetyl]-L-alanine iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure B′ and using 1-naphthylacetic acid (Aldrich) and L-alanine iso-butyl ester hydrochloride (from Example B′ above), the title compound was prepared as a solid having a melting point of 69°-73° C. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by extraction with Et2O followed by washes with aqueous K2CO3 and aqueous HCl.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=0.83 (m, 6H), 1.25 (d, J=7.1 Hz, 3H), 1.81 (m, 1H), 3.79 (m, 2H), 4.04 (2s, 2H), 4.57 (quint., J=7.3 Hz, 1H), 5.99 (d, J=7.1 Hz, 1H), 7.44 (m, 2H), 7.53 (m, 2H), 7.85 (m, 2H), 7.98 (m, 1H).
13C-nmr (CDCl3): δ=18.2, 18.81, 18.83, 27.5, 41.5, 48.2, 71.3, 123.7, 125.6, 126.1, 126.6, 128.2, 128.5, 128.7, 130.7, 132.0, 133.9, 170.3, 172.5.
C19H23NO3 (MW=313.40, Mass Spectroscopy (MH+ 314))
Example A9 Synthesis of N-[(2-naphthyl)acetyl]-L-alanine iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure B′ and using 2-naphthylacetic acid (Aldrich) and L-alanine iso-butyl ester hydrochloride (from Example B′ above), the title compound was prepared as a solid having a melting point of 128-129° C. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by extraction with Et2O followed by washes with aqueous K2CO3 and aqueous HCl.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=0.86 (m, 6H), 1.35 (d, J=7.1 Hz, 3H), 1.78 (m, 1H), 3.76 (s, 2H), 3.87 (m, 2H), 4.62 (quint., J=7.2 Hz, 1H), 6.13 (d, J=7.1 Hz, 1H), 7.41 (m, 1H), 7.48 (m, 2H), 7.74 (s, 1H), 7.83 (m, 3H).
13C-nmr (CDCl3): δ=18.4, 18.82, 18.85, 27.6, 43.7, 48.2, 71.4, 125.9, 126.3, 127.2, 127.6, 127.7, 128.2, 128.7, 132.0, 132.5, 133.5, 170.3, 172.8.
C19H23NO3 (MW=313.40, Mass Spectroscopy (MH+ 314)).
Example A10 Synthesis of N-(4-phenylbutanoyl)-L-alanine iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure B′ and using 4-phenylbutanoic acid (Aldrich) and L-alanine iso-butyl ester hydrochloride (from Example B′ above), the title compound was prepared as an oil. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by extraction with Et2O followed by washes with aqueous K2CO3 and aqueous HCl.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=0.92 (d, J=6.7 Hz, 6H), 1.38 (d, J=7.1 Hz, 3H), 1.96 (m, 3H), 2.21 (t, J=7.1 Hz, 2H), 2.64 (t, J=7.3 Hz, 2H), 3.90 (m, 2H), 4.59 (quint., J=7.2 Hz, 1H), 6.31 (d, 1H), 7.16 (m, 3H), 7.24 (m, 2H).
13C-nmr (CDCl3): δ=18.3, 18.75, 18.78, 26.8, 27.5, 34.9, 35.3, 47.8, 71.2, 125.7, 128.2, 128.3, 141.3, 172.1, 173.0.
C17H25NO3 (MW=291.39, Mass Spectroscopy (MH+ 292)).
Example A11 Synthesis of N-(5-phenylpentanoyl)-L-alanine iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure B′ and using 5-phenylpentanoic acid (Aldrich) and L-alanine iso-butyl ester hydrochloride (from Example B′ above), the title compound was prepared as an oil. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by extraction with Et2O followed by washes with aqueous K2CO3 and aqueous HCl.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=7.23 (m, 2H), 7.17 (m, 3H), 6.30 (d, 1H), 4.59 (quint., J=7.3 Hz, 1H), 3.91 (m, 2H), 2.61 (t, J=7.2 Hz, 2H), 2.22 (t, J=7.2 Hz, 2H), 1.93 (m, 1H), 1.66 (m, 4H), 1.38 (d, J=7.2 Hz, 3H), 0.92 (d, J=6.7 Hz, 6H).
13C-nmr (CDCl3): δ=173.1, 172.3, 142.0, 128.2, 128.1, 125.6, 71.2, 47.8, 36.1, 35.5, 30.8, 27.5, 25.0, 18.80, 18.77, 18.4.
C18H27NO3 (MW=305.39, Mass Spectroscopy (MH+ 306)).
Example A12 Synthesis of N-[(4-pyridyl)acetyl]-D,L-alanine iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure F′ and using 4-pyridylacetic acid hydrochloride (Aldrich) and (D,L)-alanine iso-butyl ester hydrochloride (from Example B′ above), the title compound was prepared as a solid having a melting point of 64°-66° C. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel (Rf=0.43 10% methanol/dichloromethane) and purification was by silica gel chromatography.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=8.51 (dd, J=1.6, 2.8, 1.6, 2H); 7.23 (dd, J=4.3, 1.6, 4.4, 2H); 6.71 (d, J=6.8, 1H); 4.56 (quint., J=7.3, 7.2, 1H); 3.88 (m, 2H); 3.53 (s, 2H); 1.89 (m, 1H); 1.36 (d, J=7.2, 3H); 0.88 (d, J=6.7, 6H).
13C-nmr (CDCl3): δ=173.5, 169.3, 150.5, 144.4, 125.1, 72.1, 48.9, 43.0, 28.2, 19.5, 19.5, 18.9.
C14H20N2O3 (MW=264, Mass Spectroscopy (MH+ 265))
Example A13 Synthesis of N-(phenylacetyl)-L-alanine iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure B′ and using phenylacetyl chloride (Aldrich) and L-alanine iso-butyl ester hydrochloride (from Example B′ above), the title compound was prepared as a solid having a melting point of 45°-47° C. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by extraction with Et2O followed by washes with aqueous K2CO3 and aqueous HCl.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=7.24-7.39 (m, 5H), 6.14 (d, 1H), 4.58 (t, J=7.3 Hz, 1H), 3.88 (m, 2H), 3.58 (s, 2H), 1.90 (m, 1H), 1.35 (d, J=7.2 Hz, 3H), 0.89 (d, J=6.7 Hz, 6H).
13C-nmr (CDCl3): δ=172.8, 170.4, 134.5, 129.3, 128.9, 127.2, 71.3, 48.1, 43.5, 27.5, 18.9, 18.8, 18.4.
C15H21NO3 (MW=263.34, Mass Spectroscopy (MH+ 264)).
Example A14 Synthesis of 2-[(3,4-dichlorophenyl)acetamido]butyric acid iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure I′ above and using 3,4-dichlorophenylacetic acid (Aldrich) and iso-butyl 2-aminobutyrate (prepared following General Procedure J′ above) the title compound was prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by filtration as described in the general procedure.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=7.36 (m, 3H), 6.03 (bd, 1H), 4.54 (m, 1H), 3.87 (m, 2H), 3.49 (s, 2H), 1.93 (m, 2H), 1.72 (m, 1H), 0.88 (d, 6H), 0.80 (t, 3H).
Example A15 Synthesis of 2-[(3-methoxyphenyl)acetamido]butyric acid iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure I′ above and using 3-methoxyphenylacetic acid (Aldrich) and iso-butyl 2-aminobutyrate (prepared following General Procedure J′ above), the title compound was prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by filtration as described in the general procedure.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=6.75 (m, 4H), 5.93 (bd, 1H), 4.51 (m, 1H), 3.83 (m, 2H), 3.75 (s, 2H), 3.52 (s, 2H), 1.82 (m, 2H), 1.60 (m, 1H), 0.84 (d, 6H), 0.74 (t, 3H).
C17H25NO4 (MW=307.39, Mass Spectroscopy (MH+ 309)).
Example A16 Synthesis of 2-[(4-nitrophenyl)acetamido]butyric acid iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure I′ above and using 4-nitrophenylacetic acid (Aldrich) and iso-butyl 2-aminobutyrate (prepared following General Procedure J′ above), the title compound was prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by filtration as described in the general procedure.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=8.16 (d, 2H), 7.44 (d, 2H), 6.04 (bd, 1H), 4.55 (m, 1H), 3.86 (m, 2H), 3.66 (s, 2H), 1.86 (m, 2H), 1.67 (m, 1H), 0.85 (d, 6H), 0.81 (t, 3H).
C16H22N2O5 (MW=322.36, Mass Spectroscopy (MH+ 323)).
Example A17 Synthesis of 2-[(3,4methylenedioxyphenyl)acetamido]butyric acid iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure I′ above and using 3,4-(methylenedioxy)-phenyl acetic acid (Aldrich) and iso-butyl 2-aminobutyrate (prepared following General Procedure J′ above), the title compound was prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by filtration as described in the general procedure.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=6.72 (m, 3H), 5.92 (bd, 1H), 4.54 (m, 1H), 3.86 (m, 2H), 3.66 (s, 2H), 1.86 (m, 2H), 1.66 (m, 1H), 0.89 (d, 6H), 0.79 (t, 3H).
Example A18 Synthesis of 2-[(thien-3-yl)acetamido]butyric acid iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure I′ above and using 3-thiopheneacetic acid (Aldrich) and iso-butyl 2-aminobutyrate (prepared following General Procedure J′ above), the title compound was prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by filtration as described in the general procedure.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=7.37 (m, 1H), 7.16 (m, 1H), 7.04 (m, 1H), 6.05 (bd, 1H), 4.57 (m, 1H), 3.66 (s, 2H), 1.93 (m, 2H), 1.67 (m, 1H), 0.91 (d, 6H), 0.86 (t, 3H).
Example A19 Synthesis of 2-[(4-chlorophenyl)acetamido]butyric acid iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure I′ above and using 4-chlorophenylacetic acid (Aldrich) and iso-butyl 2-aminobutyrate (prepared following General Procedure J′ above), the title compound was prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by filtration as described in the general procedure.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=7.22 (m, 2H), 7.11 (m, 2H), 5.80 (m, 1H), 4.44 (m, 1H), 3.78 (m, 2H), 3.43 (s, 2H), 1.77 (m, 2H), 1.56 (m, 1H), 0.83 (d, 6H) 0.71 (t, 3H).
Example A20 Synthesis of 2-[(3-nitrophenyl)acetamido]butyric acid iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure I′ above and using 3-nitrophenylacetic acid (Aldrich) and iso-butyl 2-aminobutyrate (prepared following General Procedure J′ above), the title compound was prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by filtration as described in the general procedure.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=8.15 (m, 2H), 7.65 (m, 1H), 6.08 (m, 1H), 4.46 (m, 1H), 3.92 (m, 2H), 3.68 (s, 2H), 1.91 (m, 2H), 1.75 (m, 1H), 0.98 (d, 6H) 0.71 (t, 3H).
Example A21 Synthesis of 2-[(2-hydroxyphenyl)acetamido]butyric acid iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure I′ above and using 2-hydroxyphenylacetic acid (Aldrich) and iso-butyl 2-aminobutyrate (prepared following General Procedure J′ above), the title compound was prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by filtration as described in the general procedure.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=7.14 (m, 1H), 7.01 (m, 1H), 6.93 (m, 1H), 6.79 (m, 1H), 6.46 (m, 1H), 4.51 (m, 1H), 3.87 (m, 2H), 3.57 (s, 2H), 2.01 (m, 2H), 1.75 (m, 1H), 0.89 (d, 6H), 0.85 (t, 3H).
Example A22 Synthesis of 2-[(2-naphthyl)acetamido]butyric acid iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure I′ above and using 2-naphthylacetic acid (Aldrich) and iso-butyl 2-aminobutyrate (prepared following General Procedure J′ above), the title compound was prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by filtration as described in the general procedure.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=7.83 (m, 7H), 5.95 (m, 1H), 4.58 (m, 1H), 3.84 (m, 2H), 3.75 (s, 2H), 1.89 (m, 2H), 1.63 (m, 1H), 0.91 (d, 6H), 0.81 (t, 3H).
C20H25NO3 (MW=327.42, Mass Spectroscopy (MH+ 328)).
Example A23 Synthesis of 2-[(2,4-dichlorophenyl)acetamido]butyric acid iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure I′ above and using 2,4-dichlorophenylacetic acid (Aldrich) and iso-butyl 2-aminobutyrate (prepared following General Procedure J′ above), the title compound was prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by filtration as described in the general procedure.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=7.49 (m, 1H), 7.22 (m, 2H) 5.98 (m, 1H), 4.52 (m, 1H), 3.86 (m, 2H), 3.61 (s, 2H), 1.84 (m, 2H), 1.62 (m, 1H) 0.87 (d, 6H), 0.80 (t, 3H).
Example A24 Synthesis of 2-[(4bromophenyl)acetamido]butyric acid iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure I′ above and using 4-bromophenylacetic acid (Aldrich) and iso-butyl 2-aminobutyrate (prepared following General Procedure J′ above), the title compound was prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by filtration as described in the general procedure.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=7.43 (d, 2H), 7.19 (d, 2H) 5.85 (m, 1H), 4.51 (m, 1H), 3.81 (m, 2H), 3.47 (s, 2H), 1.84 (m, 2H), 1.61 (m, 1H) 0.84 (d, 6H), 0.76 (t, 3H).
C16H22NO3Br (MW=356.26, Mass Spectroscopy (MH+ 358)).
Example A25 Synthesis of 2-[(3-chlorophenyl)acetamido])butyric acid iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure I′ above and using 3-chlorophenylacetic acid (Aldrich) and iso-butyl 2-aminobutyrate (prepared following General Procedure J′ above), the title compound was prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by filtration as described in the general procedure.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=7.25 (m, 3H), 7.12 (m, 1H) 5.80 (m, 1H), 4.52 (m, 1H), 3.86 (m, 2H), 3.50 (s, 2H), 1.87 (m, 2H), 1.67 (m, 1H) 0.88 (d, 6H), 0.77 (t, 3H).
C16H22NO3Cl (MW=311.81 Mass Spectroscopy (MH+ 313)).
Example A26 Synthesis of 2-[(3-fluorophenyl)acetamido]butyric acid iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure I′ above and using 3-fluorophenylacetic acid (Aldrich) and iso-butyl 2-aminobutyrate (prepared following General Procedure J′ above), the title compound was prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by filtration as described in the general procedure.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=7.31 (m, 1H), 7.01 (m, 3H) 5.95 (m, 1H), 4.54 (m, 1H), 3.84 (m, 2H), 3.54 (s, 2H), 1.88 (m, 2H), 1.65 (m, 1H) 0.87 (d, 6H), 0.81 (t, 3H).
C16H22NO3F (MW=295.35 Mass Spectroscopy (MH+ 296)).
Example A27 Synthesis of 2-[(benzothiazol-4-yl)acetamido]butyric acid iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure I′ above and using 4-benzothiazol-4-yl acetic acid (Chemservice) and iso-butyl 2-aminobutyrate (prepared following General Procedure J′ above), the title compound was prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by filtration as described in the general procedure.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=7.82 (m, 1H), 7.51-7.21 (m, 4H) 5.84 (m, 1H), 4.51 (m, 1H), 3.90 (s, 2H), 3.79 (m, 2H), 1.78 (m, 2H), 1.58 (m, 1H) 0.80 (d, 6H), 0.66 (t, 3H).
Example A28 Synthesis of 2-[(2-methylphenyl)acetamido]butyric acid iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure I′ above and using 2-methylphenylacetic acid (Aldrich) and iso-butyl 2-aminobutyrate (prepared following General Procedure J′ above), the title compound was prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by filtration as described in the general procedure.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=7.18 (m, 4H), 5.79 (m, 1H), 4.54 (m, 1H), 3.85 (m, 2H), 3.59 (s, 2H), 3.29 (s, 3H), 1.81 (m, 2H), 1.59 (m, 1H) 0.87 (d, 6H), 0.77 (t, 3H).
C17H25NO3 (MW=291.39 Mass Spectroscopy (M+ 291)).
Example A29 Synthesis of 2-[(2-fluorophenyl)acetamido]butyric acid iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure I′ above and using 2-fluorophenylacetic acid (Aldrich) and iso-butyl 2-aminobutyrate (prepared following General Procedure J′ above), the title compound was prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by filtration as described in the general procedure.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=7.28 (m, 1H), 7.09 (m, 3H) 6.03 (m, 1H), 4.54 (m, 1H), 3.87 (m, 2H), 3.57 (s, 2H), 1.89 (m, 2H), 1.64 (m, 1H) 0.88 (d, 6H), 0.80 (t, 3H).
Example A30 Synthesis of 2-[(4fluorophenyl)acetamido]butyric acid iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure I′ above and using 4-fluorophenylacetic acid (Aldrich) and iso-butyl 2-aminobutyrate (prepared following General Procedure J′ above), the title compound was prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by filtration as described in the general procedure.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=7.20 (m, 2H), 6.97 (m, 2H) 5.87 (m, 1H), 4.492 (m, 1H), 3.83 (m, 2H), 3.48 (s, 2H), 1.86 (m, 2H), 1.60 (m, 1H) 0.87 (d, 6H), 0.78 (t, 3H).
C16H22NO3F (MW=295.35 Mass Spectroscopy (MH+ 296)).
Example A31 Synthesis of 2-[(3-bromophenyl)acetamido]butyric acid iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure I′ above and using 3-bromophenylacetic acid (Aldrich) and iso-butyl 2-aminobutyrate (prepared following General Procedure J′ above), the title compound was prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by filtration as described in the general procedure.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=7.45 (m, 2H), 7.23 (m, 2H) 5.95 (m, 1H), 4.55 (m, 1H) 3.84 (m, 2H) 3.55 (s, 2H), 1.89 (m, 2H), 1.68 (m, 1H) 0.91 (d, 6H), 0.81 (t, 3H).
C16H22NO3Br (MW=356.26 Mass Spectroscopy (M+ 357)).
Example A32 Synthesis of 2-[(3-trifluoromethylphenyl)acetamido]butyric acid iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure I′ above and using 3-trifluoromethyl-phenylacetic acid (Aldrich) and iso-butyl 2-aminobutyrate (prepared following General Procedure J′ above), the title compound was prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by filtration as described in the general procedure.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=7.52 (m, 1H), 7.47 (m, 2H) 6.01 (m, 1H), 4.56 (m, 1H), 3.86 (m, 2H), 3.61 (s, 2H), 1.84 (m, 2H), 1.62 (m, 1H) 0.87 (d, 6H), 0.80 (t, 3H).
C17H22NO3F3 (MW=345.36 Mass Spectroscopy (M+ 345)).
Example A33 Synthesis of 2-[(2-thienyl)acetamido]butyric acid iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure I′ above and using 2-thiopheneacetic acid (Aldrich) and iso-butyl 2-aminobutyrate (prepared following General Procedure J′ above), the title compound was prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by filtration as described in the general procedure.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=6.89 (m, 3H), 6.07 (bd, 1H), 4.50 (m, 1H), 3.82 (m, 2H), 3.71 (s, 2H), 1.85 (m, 2H), 1.62 (m, 1H), 0.81 (d, 6H), 0.75 (t, 3H).
C14H21NO3S (MW=283.39, Mass Spectroscopy (MH+ 284)).
Example A34 Synthesis of 2-(phenylacetamido)butyric acid iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure H′ above and using phenylacetic acid (Aldrich) and iso-butyl 2-aminobutyrate (prepared following General Procedure J′ above), the title compound was prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by chromatography on silica gel using 9:1 toluene:EtOAc as the eluant.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=7.17-7.28 (m, 5H), 6.23 (bd, 1H), 4.51 (m, 1H), 3.86 (m, 2H), 3.54 (s, 2H), 1.87 (m, 2H), 1.62 (m, 1), 0.87 (d, 6H), 0.78 (t, 3H).
C16H23NO3 (MW=277.36, Mass Spectroscopy (M+ 277)).
Example A35 Synthesis of N-(phenylacetyl)valine 2-methylbutyl ester
Step A. Preparation of N-(phenylacetyl) valine
To a stirred solution of 5.15 g (44 mmol) of valine (Bachem) in 50 mL (100 mmol) of 2N NaOH cooled to 0° C. was added dropwise 5.3 mL (40 mmol) of phenylacetyl chloride (Aldrich). A colorless oil precipitated. The reaction mixture was allowed to warm to room temperature and stirred for 18 hours, washed with 50 mL diethyl ether, acidified to pH 2-3 with aqueous HCl. The white precipitate formed was filtered off, washed thoroughly with water, followed by diethyl ether to give 7.1 g (30 mmol, 69% yield) of the title compound.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (DMSO-d6): δ=12.63 (s, 1H), 8.25 (d, J=8.6 Hz, 1H), 7.27 (m, 5H), 4.15 (m, 1H), 3.56 (d, J=13.8 Hz, 1H), 3.47 (d, J=13.8 Hz, 1H), 2.05 (m, 1H), 0.87 (d, J=6.8, Hz, 3H), 0.84 (d, J=6.8 Hz, 3)
13C-nmr (DMSO-d6): δ=173.2, 170.4, 136.6, 129.0, 128.2, 126.3, 57.1, 41.9, 30.0, 19.2, 18.0
C13H17NO3 (MW=235.29; Mass Spectroscopy (MH+ =236))
Step B. Synthesis of N-(phenylacetyl)valine 2-methylbutyl ester
Following General Procedure C′ and using the N-(phenylacetyl) valine prepared in Step A above and 2-methylbutan-1-ol (Aldrich), the title compound was prepared as a diastereomeric mixture. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by filtration as described in the general procedure.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=7.25-7.40 (m, 5H), 5.95 (d, 1H), 4.56 (m, 1H), 3.84-4.00 (m, 2H), 3.61 (s, 2H), 2.10 (m, 1H), 1.68 (m, 1H), 1.38 (m, 1H) 1.15 (m 1H), 0.82-0.94 (m, 9H), 0.76 (d, 3H).
13C-nmr (CDCl3): δ=171.84, 171.81, 170.7, 134.6, 129.31, 129.27, 128.9, 127.3, 69.8, 57.0, 43.7, 33.9, 31.3, 25.9, 25.8, 18.9, 17.4, 16.34, 16.27, 11.12, 11.07.
C18H27NO3 (MW=305.42, Mass Spectroscopy (MH 306)).
Example A36 Synthesis of N-(phenylacetyl)-L-methionine iso-butyl ester
L-Methionine (0.129 g, 0.869 mmols) (Aldrich) was taken-up in dioxane (5.0 mL) and treated with a saturated solution of sodium bicarbonate (5.0 mL) followed by phenylacetyl chloride (Aldrich) (0.114 mL, 0.822 mmols). After stirring for 17 hours at room temperature the mixture was diluted with ethyl acetate, the layers separated and the aqueous layer acidified to pH 2 with 5N HCl. The crude product was extracted into ethyl acetate, dried over sodium sulfate, vacuum dried and used without further purification.
N-phenylacetyl-L-methionine (0.1285 g, 0.447 mmol) was dissolved in 3.0 mL dioxane and iso-butyl alcohol (0.2 mL) and treated with EDC (0.094 g, 0.492 mmol), and catalytic DMAP (0.015 g). After stirring for 17 hours at 23° C., the mixture was evaporated at reduced pressure to an oil, the residue was diluted in EtOAc and washed with 0.1 N HCl and saturated sodium bicarbonate. Chromatography on silica gel using 98:2 CHCl3/MeOH as eluant provided the pure product.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=7.4-7.23 (m, 5H), 6.14 (bd, 1H), 4.70 (m, 1H), 3.89 (d, 2H), 3.62 (s, 2H), 2.43 (m, 2H), 2.12 (m, 1H), 1.93 (m, 2H), 0.94 (d, 6H).
C17H25NO3S (MW=323.17, Mass Spectroscopy (M+ 323)
Example A37 Synthesis of N-(phenylacetyl)-L-leucine iso-butyl ester
L-Leucine (Aldrich) (0.114 g, 0.869 mmols) was taken-up in dioxane (5.0 mL) and treated with a saturated solution of sodium bicarbonate (5.0 mL) followed by phenylacetyl chloride (Aldrich) (0.114 mL, 0.822 mmols). After stirring for 17 hours at room temperature the mixture was diluted with ethyl acetate, the layers separated and the aqueous layer acidified to pH 2 with 5N HCl. The crude product was extracted into ethyl acetate, dried over sodium sulfate, vacuum dried and used without further purification.
N-Phenylacetyl-L-leucine (0.0081 g, 0.038 mmol) was dissolved in 2.0 mL CHCl3 (EtOH free) and iso-butyl alcohol (0.055 mL) and treated with P-EPC (100 mg, 0.87 milliequivalents). The mixture was rotated for 4 days, filtered through a plug of cotton and the filtrate evaporated at reduced pressure to an oil which was sufficiently pure for testing.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=7.22 (m, 5H), 5.57 (d, 1H), 4.35 (m, 1H), 3.35 (m, 3H), 1.35 (m, 4H), 0.68 (m, 9H).
C18H27NO3 (MW=305.40, Mass Spectroscopy (M+ 305)).
Example A38 Synthesis of N-[(3-chlorophenyl)acetyl]alanine 3-methylbut-2-enyl ester
Following General Procedure C′ above and using N-(3-chlorophenylacetyl alanine (from Example D′ above) and 3-methylbut-2-en-1-ol (Aldrich), the title compound can be prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by liquid chromatography using 30% EtOAc/hexane as the eluant.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=7.39-7.16 (m, 4H), 6.06 (bd, 1H), 5.38-5.29 (m, 1H), 4.63 (d, J=9 Hz, 2H), 3.56 (s, 2H), 1.79 (s, 3H), 1.7 (s, 3H), 1.39 J=9 Hz, 3H).
Example A39 Synthesis of N-[(3-chlorophenyl)acetyl]alanine cyclopropylmethyl ester
Following General Procedure C′ above, and using N-(3-chlorophenylacetyl alanine (from Example D′ above) and cyclopropylmethanol (Aldrich), the title compound can be prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by liquid chromatography using 3:7 EtOAc:hexane as the eluant.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=7.2-7.1 (m, 4H), 6.09 (bs, 1H), 4.6 (dq, J=9 Hz, 1H), 3.96 (dd, J=9 Hz, 2H), 3.59 (s, 2H), 1.2 (d, J=9 Hz, 3H), 1.2-1.0 (m, 1H), 0.60-0.50 (m, 2H), 0.30-0.20 (m, 2H).
Example A40 Synthesis of N-[(3-chlorophenyl)acetyl]alanine 2-thienylmethyl ester
Following General Procedure C′ above, and using N-(3-chlorophenylacetyl alanine (from Example D′ above) and 2-thiophenemethanol (Aldrich) the title compound can be prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by liquid chromatography using 3:7 EtOAc:hexane as the eluant.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=7.37-6.97 (m, 7H), 5.97 (q, J=14 Hz, 2H), 4.6 (dq, J=9 Hz, 1H), 3.76 (s, 2H), 1.38 (d, J=9 Hz, 3H).
Example A41 Synthesis of N-[(3-chlorophenyl)acetyl]alanine (1-methylcyclopropyl)methyl ester
Following General Procedure C′ above, and using N-(3-chlorophenylacetyl alanine (from Example D′ above) and (1-methylcyclopropyl)methanol (Aldrich) the title compound can be prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by liquid chromatography using 3:7 EtOAc:hexane as the eluant.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=8.6 (bd, J=9 Hz, 1H), 3.86 (q, J=14 Hz, 2H), 3.4 (s, 2H), 2.29 (q, J=9 Hz, 1H), 1.3 (d, J=9 Hz, 3H), 1.03 (s, 3H), 0.5-0.4 (m, 2H), 0.4-0.28 (m, 2H).
Example A42 Synthesis of N-[(3-chlorophenyl)acetyl]alanine 3-thienylmethyl ester
Following General Procedure C′ above, and using N-(3-chlorophenylacetyl alanine (from Example D′ above) and 3-thiophenemethanol (Aldrich) the title compound can be prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by liquid chromatography using 3:7 EtOAc:hexane as the eluant.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=8.03 (bd, J=9 Hz, 1H), 7.56-7.5 (m, 1H), 7.47 (bs, 1H), 7.4-7.17 (m, 4H), 7.06 (d, J=9 Hz, 1H), 5.1 (s, 2H), 4.3 (dq, 1H), 1.3 (d, J=9 Hz, 3H).
Example A43 Synthesis of N-[(3-chlorophenyl)acetyl]alanine 2-methylcyclopentyl ester
Following General Procedure C′ above, and using N-(3-chlorophenylacetyl alanine (from Example D′ above) and 2-methylcyclopentanol (Aldrich) the title compound can be prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by liquid chromatography using 3:7 EtOAc:hexane as the eluant.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=7.39-7.16 (m, 4H), 6.3 (bd, 1H), 4.79-4.7 (m, 1H), 4.6-4.25 (m, J=9 Hz, 1H), 3.58 (s, 2H), 2.09-1.8 (m, 2H), 1.74-1.6 (m, 2H), 1.39 (dd, J=9 Hz, 3H), 1.2 (dt, J=9 Hz, 1H), 0.98 (dd, J=9 Hz, 2H)
C17H22NO3Cl (MW=323.82, Mass Spectroscopy (M+ 323).
Example A44 Synthesis of N-[(3-chlorophenyl)acetyl]alanine 2-methylprop-2-enyl ester
Following General Procedure C′ above, and using N-(3-chlorophenylacetyl alanine (from Example D′ above) and 2-methylprop-2-en-1-ol (Aldrich) the title compound can be prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by liquid chromatography using 3:7 EtOAc:hexane as the eluant.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=7.39-7.16 (m, 4H), 6.03 (bs, 1H), 4.77 (s, 2H), 4.7-4.29 (m, 3H), 2.59 (s, 2H), 1.73 (s, 3H), 1.43 (d, J=9 Hz, 3H)
C15H18NO3Cl (MW=295.76, Mass Spectroscopy (M+ 295)).
Example A45 Synthesis of N-[(3-chlorophenyl)acetyl]alanine cyclohex-2-enyl ester
Following General Procedure C′ above, and using N-(3-chlorophenylacetyl alanine (from Example D′ above) and cyclohex-2-en-1-ol (Aldrich) the title compound can be prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by liquid chromatography using 3:7 EtOAc:hexane as the eluant.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=8.6 (bd, J=9 Hz, 1H), 7.4-7.2 (m, 4H), 6.0-5.8 (m, 1H), 5.7-5.5 (m, 1H), 5.1 (bs, 1H), 4.13-4.29 (m, 1H), 3.5 (s, 2H), 2.1-1.9 (m, 2H), 1.8-1.69 (m, 1H), 1.69-1.49 (m, 4H), 1.3 (dd, J=9 Hz, 3H)
C17H20NO3Cl (MW=321.8, Mass Spectroscopy (M+ 321.2)).
Example A46 Synthesis of N-[(2-phenylbenzoxazol-5-yl)acetyl]alanine iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure I′ above, and using 5-(2-phenylbenzoxazol)-yl-acetic acid (CAS# 62143-69-5) and alanine iso-butyl ester (prepared following General Procedure J′ above), the title compound was prepared.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=8.24 (m, 3H), 7.68 (m, 1H), 7.51 (m, 5H), 6.04 (m, 1H), 4.58 (m, 1H), 3.85 (m, 2H), 3.68 (s, 2H), 1.9 (m, 1H), 1.35 (d, 3H), 0.87 (d, 6H).
C22H24N2O4 (MW=380, Mass Spectroscopy (MH+ 381)).
Example A47 Synthesis of N-[(3-methylthiophenyl)acetyl]alanine iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure I′ above, and using 3-methylthiophenylacetic acid (CAS# 18698-73-2) and alanine iso-butyl ester (prepared following General Procedure J′ above), the title compound was prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by filtration as described in the general procedure.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=7.14 (m, 2H), 7.01 (m, 1H), 4.56 (m, 1H), 3.88 (m, 2H), 3.54 (s, 2H), 2.46 (s, 3H), 1.89 (m, 1H), 1.35 (d, 3H) 0.85 (d, 6H).
C16H23NO3S (MW=309, Mass Spectroscopy (MH+ 310)).
Example A48 Synthesis of N-4-[(2-furyl)acetyl]alanine iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure I′ above, and using 2-furylacetic acid (CAS# 2745-26-8) and alanine iso-butyl ester (prepared following General Procedure J′ above), the title compound was prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by filtration as described in the general procedure.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=7.36 (m, 1H), 6.34 (m, 1H), 6.21 (m, 1H), 4.56 (m, 1H), 3.91 (m, 2H), 3.61 (s, 2H), 1.92 (m, 1H), 1.38 (d, 3H) 0.89 (d, 6H).
C13H19NO4 (MW=253, Mass Spectroscopy (MH+ 254)).
Example A49 Synthesis of N-[(benzofuran-2-yl)acetyl]alanine iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure I′ above, and using benzofuran-2-ylacetic acid (Maybridge) and alanine iso-butyl ester (prepared following General Procedure J′ above), the title compound was prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by filtration as described in the general procedure.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=7.51 (m, 1H), 7.44 (m, 1H),7.25 (m, 2H), 6.67 (s, 1H), 4.60 (m, 1H), 3.87 (m, 2H), 3.77 (s, 2H), 1.88 (m, 1H), 1.38 (d, 3H), 0.87 (d, 6H).
C17H21NO4 (MW=303, Mass Spectroscopy (MH+ 304)).
Example A50 Synthesis of N-[(benzothiophen-3-yl)acetyl]alanine iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure I′ above, and using thianaphthen-3-ylacetic acid (Lancaster) and alanine iso-butyl ester (prepared following General Procedure J′ above), the title compound was prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by filtration as described in the general procedure.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=7.89 (m, 1H), 7.76 (m, 1H), 7.38 (m, 3H), 6.07 (m, 1H), 4.57 (m, 1H), 3.92 (m, 2H), 3.82 (s, 4H), 1.84 (m, 1H), 1.32 (d, 3H) 0.85 (d, 6H).
C17H21NO3S (MW=319, Mass Spectroscopy (MH+ 320)).
Example A51 Synthesis of N-[(2-chloro-5-thienyl)acetyl]alanine iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure I′ above, and using 5-chloro-2-thienyl)acetic acid (CAS# 13669-19-7) and alanine iso-butyl ester (prepared following General Procedure J′ above), the title compound was prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by filtration as described in the general procedure.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=6.77 (m, 1H), 6.68 (d, 1H), 6.31 (bm, 1H), 4.59 (m, 1H), 3.91 (m, 2H), 3.38 (s, 2H), 1.90 (m, 1H), 1.39 (d, 3H) 0.89 (d, 6H).
C13H18NO3SCl (MW=303, Mass Spectroscopy (M+ 303)).
Example A52 Synthesis of N-[(3-methylisoxazol-5-yl)acetyl]alanine iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure I′ above, and using (3-methyl-isoxazol-5-yl)acetic acid (CAS# 19668-85-0) and alanine iso-butyl ester (prepared following General Procedure J′ above), the title compound was prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by filtration as described in the general procedure.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=6.07 (s, 2H), 4.56 (m, 1H), 3.92 (m, 2H), 3.68 (s, 2H), 2.29 (s, 3H), 1.94 (m, 1H), 1.89 (d, 3H) 0.91 (d, 6H).
C13H20N2O4 (MW=268, Mass Spectroscopy (MH+ 269)).
Example A53 Synthesis of N-[(2-phenylthiothienyl)acetyl]alanine iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure I′ above, and using (2-phenyl-thiothienyl)acetic acid and alanine iso-butyl ester (prepared following General Procedure J′ above), the title compound was prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by filtration as described in the general procedure.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=7.21-7.11 (m, 6H), 6.92 (d, 1H), 4.56 (m, 1H), 3.87 (m, 2H), 3.72 (s, 2H), 1.94 (m, 1H), 1.38 (d, 3H) 0.89 (d, 6H).
C19H23NO3S2 (MW=377, Mass Spectroscopy (MH+ 378)).
Example A54 Synthesis of N-[(6methoxybenzothiophen-2-yl)acetyl]alanine iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure I′ above, and using (6-methoxybenzothiophen-2-yl)acetic acid and alanine iso-butyl ester (prepared following General Procedure J′ above), the title compound was prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by filtration as described in the general procedure.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=7.59 (d, 1H), 7.33 (d, 1H), 7.16 (s, 1H), 7.03 (dd, 1H), 4.56 (m, 1H), 3.87 (s, 3H), 3.84 (m, 2H), 3.76 (s, 2H),1.85 (m, 1H), 1.30 (d, 3H) 0.86 (d, 6H).
C18H23NO4S (MW=349, Mass Spectroscopy (MH+ 350)).
Example A55 Synthesis of N-[(3-phenyl-1,2,4-thiadiazol-5-yl)acetyl]alanine iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure I′ above, and using (3-phenyl-1,2,4-thiadiazol-5-yl)acetic acid (CAS# 90771-06-5) and alanine iso-butyl ester (prepared following General Procedure J′ above), the title compound was prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by filtration as described in the general procedure.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=7.47 (m, 5H), 4.66 (m, 1H), 4.16 (s, 2H), 3.91 (m, 2H), 1.93 (m, 1H), 1.48 (d, 3H) 0.93 (d, 6H).
C17H21N3O3S (MW=347, Mass Spectroscopy (MH+ 348)).
Example A56 Synthesis of N-[2-phenyloxazol-4-yl)acetyl]alanine iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure I′ above, and using (2-phenyloxazol-4-yl)acetic acid (CAS# 22086-89-1) and alanine iso-butyl ester (prepared following General Procedure J′ above), the title compound was prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by filtration as described in the general procedure.
NMR data was as follows:
Example A57 Synthesis of N-[(3-methylphenyl)acetyl]alanine iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure I′ above, and using 3-methylphenylacetic acid (Aldrich) and alanine iso-butyl ester (prepared following General Procedure J′ above), the title compound was prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by filtration as described in the general procedure.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=7.21 (m, 1H), 7.07 (m, 3H), 4.54 (m, 1H), 3.83 (m, 2H), 3.52 (s, 2H), 2.35 (s, 3H), 1.87 (m, 1H), 1.32 (d, 3H), 0.88 (d, 6H).
C16H23NO3 (MW=277, Mass Spectroscopy (MH+ 278)).
Example A58 Synthesis of N-[(2,5-difluorophenyl)acetyl]alanine iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure I′ above, and using 2,5-difluorophenylacetic acid (Aldrich) and alanine iso-butyl ester (prepared following General Procedure J′ above), the title compound was prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by filtration as described in the general procedure.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=7.08-6.94 (m, 3H), 4.57 (m, 1H), 3.91 (m, 2H), 3.56 (s, 2H), 1.92 (m, 1H), 1.41 (d, 3H) 0.91 (d, 6H).
C15H19NO3F2 (MW=299, Mass Spectroscopy (MH+ 300)).
Example A59 Synthesis of N-[(3,5-diflurophenyl)acetyl]alanine iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure I′ above, and using 3,5-difluorophenylacetic acid (Aldrich) and alanine iso-butyl ester (prepared following General Procedure J′ above), the title compound was prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by filtration as described in the general procedure.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=6.81 (m, 2H), 6.74 (m, 1H), 6.06 (m, 1H), 4.57 (m, 1H), 3.92 (m, 2H), 3.51 (s, 2H), 1.94 (m, 1H), 1.36 (d, 3H) 0.87 (d, 6H).
C15H19NO3F2 (MW=299, Mass Spectroscopy (MH+ 300)).
Example A60 Synthesis of N-[(3-thienyl)acetyl]alanine iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure I′ above, and using 3-thiopheneacetic acid (Aldrich) and alanine iso-butyl ester (prepared following General Procedure J′ above), the title compound was prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by filtration as described in the general procedure.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=7.33 (m, 1H), 7.14 (m, 1H), 7.01 (m, 1H), 6.09 (m, 1H), 4.58 (m, 1H), 3.88 (m, 2H), 3.60 (s, 2H), 1.91 (m, 1H), 1.37 (d, 3H) 0.92 (d, 6H).
Optical Rotation: [α]23 −52 (c 1 MeOH) @589 nm.
C13H19NO3S (MW=269, Mass Spectroscopy (MH+ 269)).
Example A61 Synthesis of N-[(4-methylphenyl)acetyl]-L-alanine iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure I′ above, and using 4-methylphenylacetic acid (Aldrich) and L-alanine iso-butyl ester (prepared following General Procedure J′ above), the title compound was prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by filtration as described in the general procedure.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=7.11 (s, 4H), 5.93 (m, 1H), 4.58 (m, 1H), 3.88 (m, 2H), 3.54 (s, 2H), 2.33 (s, 3H), 1.89 (m, 1H), 1.32 (d, 3H), 0.89 (d, 6H).
C16H23NO3 (MW=277.35, Mass Spectroscopy (MH+ 278)).
Example A62 Synthesis of N-(phenylacetyl)-L-alanine S-1-(methoxycarbonyl) iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure K′ and using (S)-(+)-2-hydroxy-2-methylbutyric acid (Aldrich) in place of the amino acid, methyl (S)-(+)-2-hydroxy-2-methylbutyrate was prepared.
Methyl (S)-(+)-2-hydroxy-2-methylbutyrate was then coupled with carbobenzyloxy-L-alanine (Aldrich) using General Procedure E′ to provide carbobenzyloxy-L-alanine S-1-(methoxycarbonyl) iso-butyl ester.
Carbobenzyloxy-L-alanine S-1-(methoxycarbonyl) iso-butyl ester (1.0 g) was then dissolved in 20 mL of methanol and 6N HCl (0.5 mL) and 10% palladium on carbon (0.1 g) were added. This reaction mixture was hydrogenated at 40 psi of hydrogen on a Parr apparatus for 5 hours at room temperature and then filtered through a pad of Celite. The filtrate was concentrated at reduced pressure to provide L-alanine S-1-(methoxycarbonyl) iso-butyl ester hydrochloride (98% yield).
L-Alanine S-1-(methoxycarbonyl) iso-butyl ester hydrochloride was then coupled to phenylacetic acid using General Procedure G′ to provide the title compound.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=7.35-7.20 (m, 5H), 6.22 (bd, 1H), 4.83 (d, 1H), 4.65 (p, 1H), 3.68 (s, 3H), 3.55 (s, 2H), 2.21 (m, 1H), 1.40 (d, 3H), 0.97 (d, 3H), 0.93 (d, 3H).
13C-nmr (CDCl3): δ=173.25, 171.18, 170.22, 135.11, 129.94, 129.50, 127.88, 52.67, 48.49, 43.98, 30.53, 19.21, 18.75, 17.58.
Example A63 Synthesis of N-[(3-nitrophenyl)acetyl]-L-alanine iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure H′ above and using 3-nitrophenylacetic acid (Aldrich) and L-alanine iso-butyl ester hydrochloride (from Example B′ above), the title compound was prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by recrystallization from butyl chloride.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=8.17 (m, 2H), 7.68 (d, 1H), 7.52 (t, 1H), 6.18 (m, 1H), 4.48 (m, 1H), 3.94 (m, 2H), 3.67 (s, 2H), 1.93 (m, 1H), 1.42 (d, 3H), 0.91 (d, 3H).
Optical Rotation: [α]23 −49 (c 5, MeOH).
Example A64 Synthesis of N-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)acetyl]alanine ethyl ester
Following General Procedure G′ and using 3,5-difluorophenylacetic acid (Aldrich) and alanine ethyl ester (Aldrich), the title compound was prepared as a solid with a melting point of 93°-95° C. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel (Rf=0.8 in EtOAC) and purification was by chromatography on silica gel using EtOAc as the eluant followed by recrystallization from 1-chlorobutane.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (DMSO-d6): δ=1.30 (d, 3H); 3.52 (s, 2H).
C13H15NO3F2 (MW=271.26, Mass Spectroscopy (M+ 271)).
Example A65 Synthesis of N-[(3-nitrophenyl)acetyl]methionine ethyl ester
Following General Procedure G′ above and using 3-nitrophenylacetic acid (Aldrich) and methionine ethyl ester hydrochloride (Aldrich), the title compound was prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by recrystallization from butyl chloride.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=8.18 (s, 1H), 8.15 (d, 1H) 7.66 (d, 1H), 7.48 (t, 1H), 6.30 (m, 1H), 4.67 (m, 1H), 4.21 (t, 2H), 3.67 (s, 2H), 2.47 (t, 2H), 2.12 (m, 2 H), 2.08 (s, 3H), 1.27 (t, 3H).
Optical Rotation: [α]23 −30 (c 5, MeOH).
Example A66 Synthesis of N-[(3-chlorophenyl)acetyl]alanine iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure G′ above and using 3-chlorophenylacetic acid (Aldrich) and alanine iso-butyl ester (prepared following General Procedure J′ above), the title compound was prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=7.29 (m, 3H), 7.18 (m, 1H), 6.0 (m, 1H), 4.56 (m, 1H), 3.89 (m, 2H), 3.53 (s, 2H), 1.91 (m, 1H), 1.39 (d, 3 H), 0.91 (d, 3H).
Optical Rotation: [α]23 −45 (c 5, MeOH).
C15H20NO3Cl (MW=297.78, Mass Spectroscopy (MH+ 297)).
Example A67 Synthesis of N-[(3-chlorophenyl)acetyl]alanine 2-(N,N-diinethylamino)ethyl ester
Following General Procedure C′ above, and using N-(3-chlorophenyl-acetyl)alanine (from Example D′ above) and 2-(N,N-dimethyl amino) ethanol (Aldrich), the title compound can be prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by liquid chromatography using 0.1:2:0.79 NH4OH:EtOH:CHCl3 as the eluant.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): 7.37 (s, 1H), 7.33-7.2 (m, 3H), 4.675-4.6 (m, 1H), 4.5-4.37 (m, 1H), 4.25-4.13 (m, 1H), 3.6 (d, J=7 Hz, 2H), 2.86 (bs, 2H), 2.3 (s, 6H), 1.23 (d, J=9 Hz, 3H).
C15H21N2O3Cl (MW=313.799, Mass Spectroscopy (M+ 313)).
Example A68 Synthesis of 2-[(3,5-dichlorophenyl)acetamido]hexanoic acid methyl ester
Following General Procedure F′ above, an using 3,5-dichlorophenylacetic acid (from Example C′ above) and L-norleucine methyl ester hydrochloride (Bachem), the title compound was prepared as a solid having a melting point of 77°-78° C. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel (Rf=0.70 in 40% EtOAC/hexanes) and purification was by flash chromatography on silica gel using 40% EtOAc/hexanes as the eluant.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=7.20 (s), 7.18 (s), 6.6 (m), 4.55 (m), 3.7 (s), 3.5 (s), 3.4 (s), 2.0 (s), 1.8 (m), 1.6 (m), 1.2 (m), 0.8 (t).
13C-nmr (CDCl3): δ=173.54, 169.67, 138.43, 135.72, 128.33, 128.07, 78.04, 77.62, 77.19, 53.04, 52.90, 43.14, 32.57, 27.87, 22.81, 14.41.
Example A69 Synthesis of N-[(3,5-diclorophenyl)acetyl]-L-alanine iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure F′ above, and using 3,5-dichlorophenylacetic acid (from Example C′ above) and L-alanine iso-butyl ester hydrochloride (from Example B′ above), the title compound was prepared as a solid having a melting point of 115°-116° C. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel (Rf=0.40 in 3% methanol/dichloromethane) and purification was by flash chromatography on silica gel using 3% methanol/dichloromethane as the eluant.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=7.27 (d, J=2 Hz, 1H), 7.19 (s, 2H), 6.22 (d, J=6 Hz, 1H), 4.59 (quint., J=7 Hz, 1H), 3.9 (q, J=4 Hz, 2H), 3.5 (s, 2H), 1.9 (m, 1H), 1.4 (d, J=7 Hz, 3H), 0.91 (d, J=7 Hz, 6H).
13C-nmr (CDCl3): δ=173.45, 169.37, 138.31, 135.75, 128.39, 128.11, 78.04, 77.61, 77.19, 72.19, 54.03, 48.97, 43.12, 28.24, 19.52, 19.49, 19.09.
C15H19NO3Cl2 (MW=331.9, Mass Spectroscopy (MH+ 332)).
Example A70 Synthesis of N-(cyclohexylacetyl)-L-alanine iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure B′ above, and using cyclohexylacetic acid (Aldrich) and L-alanine iso-butyl ester hydrochloride (from Example B′ above), the title compound was prepared as a solid having a melting point of 92° C.-93° C. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel (Rf=0.39 in 1:3 EtOAc:hexane) and purification was by extraction with Et2O followed by washes with aqueous K2CO3 and aqueous HCl.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=0.93 (d, J=6.7 Hz, 6H), 0.85-1.01 (m, 2H), 1.05-1.35 (m, 3H), 1.40 (d, J=7.1 Hz, 3H), 1.60-1.85 (m, 6H), 1.95 (m, 1H), 2.06 (d, J=7.0 Hz, 2H), 3.92 (m, 2H), 4.61 (m, 1H), 6.08 (bd, 1H).
13C-nmr (CDCl3): δ=18.7, 18.9, 26.0, 26.1, 27.6, 33.0, 35.3, 44.6, 47.9, 71.4, 171.8, 173.3.
C15H27NO3 (MW=269.39, Mass Spectroscopy (MH+ 270)).
Example A71 Synthesis of N-(cyclopentylacetyl)-L-alanine iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure B′ above, and using cyclopentylacetic acid (Aldrich) and L-alanine iso-butyl ester hydrochloride (from Example B′ above), the title compound was prepared as a solid having a melting point of 62° C.-64° C. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel (Rf=0.37 in 1:3 EtOAc:hexane) and purification was by extraction with Et2O followed by washes with aqueous K2CO3 and aqueous HCl.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=0.87 (d, J=6.8 Hz, 6H), 1.01-1.17 (m, 2H), 1.34 (d, J=7.2 Hz, 3H), 1.40-1.62 (m, 4H), 1.70-1.83 (m, 2H), 1.89 (m, 1H), 2.15 (m, 3H), 3.86 (m, 2H), 4.55 (m, 1H), 6.30 (d, J=7.1 Hz, 1H).
13C-nmr (CDCl3): δ=18.4, 18.78, 18.80, 24.8 (very high), 27.5, 32.27, 32.32, 36.9, 42.5, 47.7, 71.2, 172.2, 173.2.
Elemental Analysis-Calc (%): C, 65.85; H, 9.87; N, 5.49; Found (%): C, 66.01; H, 10.08; N, 5.49.
C14H25NO3 (MW=255.36, Mass Spectroscopy (MH+ 256)).
Example A72 Synthesis of N-[(cyclohex-1-enyl)acetyl]-L-alanine iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure B′ above, and using cyclohex-1-enyl acetic acid (Alfa) and L-alanine iso-butyl ester hydrochloride (from Example B′ above), the title compound was prepared as a solid having a melting point of 49° C.-51° C. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel (Rf=0.40 in 1:3 EtOAc:hexane) and purification was by extraction with Et2O followed by washes with aqueous K2CO3 and aqueous HCl.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=0.91 (d, J=4.5 Hz, 3H), 0.93 (d, J=6.7 Hz, 3H), 1.40 (d, J=7.2 Hz, 3H), 1.52-1.70 (m, 4H), 1.97 (m, 3H), 2.06 (bs, 2H), 2.89 (s, 2H), 3.92 (m, 2H), 4.59 (m, 1H), 5.65 (s, 1H), 6.33 (d, J=6.6 Hz, 1H).
13 C-nmr (CDCl3): δ=18.7, 18.91, 18.93, 21.9, 22.7, 25.3, 27.6, 28.3, 46.1, 47.9, 71.4, 127.1, 132.5, 170.6, 173.1.
Elemental Analysis-Calc (%): C, 67.38; H, 9.42; N, 5.24; Found (%): C, 67.34; H, 9.54; N, 5.16.
C15H25NO3 (MW=267.37, Mass Spectroscopy (MH+ 268)).
Example A73 Synthesis of N-[(3-chlorophenyl)acetyl]alanine 3-methylbut-2-enyl thioester
Following General Procedure C′ above, and using N-[(3-chlorophenyl)acetyl]alanine and 3-methyl-2-butene thioester (TCI), the title compound can be prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel and purification was by liquid chromatography using 3:7 EtOAc:Hexane as the eluant.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (DMSO-d6): δ=5.2-5.075 (m, 1H), 4.37 (dq, J=9 Hz, 1H), 3.56 (s), 3.43 (d, J=12 Hz, 2H), 1.266 (d, J=12 Hz, 6H) 1.3 (d, J=9 Hz, 3H).
C16H20NO2ClS (MW=325.86, Mass Spectroscopy (M+ 325)).
Example A74 Synthesis of N-[(2-phenyl)-2-fluoroacetyl]alanine ethyl ester
Following General Procedure F′ above, and using α-fluorophenyl acetic acid (Aldrich) and alanine ethyl ester (Aldrich), the title compound was prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel (Rf=0.75 in 1:1 EtOAc:hexane) and purification was by chromatography on silica gel using 1:2 ethyl acetate/hexanes as the eluent.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (DMSO-d6): δ=1.14 (q, 3H), 1.34 (d, 3H), 4.07 (m, 2H), 4.33 (m, 1H), 5.84 (d, 1H), 6.01 (d, 1H), 7.40-7.55 (m, 5H), 8.87 (m, 1H).
C13H16NO3F (MW=253.27, Mass Spectroscopy (M+ 253)).
Example A75 Synthesis of N-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-phenylglycine methyl ester
Following General Procedure F above, and using 3,5-difluorophenylacetic acid (Aldrich) and L-phenylglycine methyl ester hydrochloride (Bachem), the title compound was prepared.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=7.4-7.3 (m, 5H), 6.9-6.7 (m, 3H), 6.55 (d 1H, 7.1 Hz), 5.56 (d 1H 7 Hz), 3.72 (s 3H), 3.57 (s 2H)
13C-nmr (CDCl3): δ=197.6, 177.6, 171.8, 169.3, 136.7, 129.6, 129.3, 127.8, 113.0, 112.9, 112.7, 111.4, 103.8, 103.5, 65.1, 57.2, 53.5, 45.1, 43.3, 43.3
C17H15NO3F2 (MW=319.31, Mass Spectroscopy (MH+320)).
Example A76 Synthesis of N-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-phenylglycine iso-butyl ester
The 3,5-difluorophenylacetic acid (Aldrich) was EDC coupled to L-phenylglycine methyl ester hydrochloride (Bachem) via General Procedure F above.
The resulting compound was placed in a large excess of the desired alcohol. A catalytic amount of dry NaH was added, and the reaction was followed by tlc until the presence of starting material was no longer detected. The reaction was quenched with a few milliliters of 1N HCl, and after a few minutes of stirring saturated aqueous NaHCO, was added. The volume of the reaction mixture was reduced on a rotary evaporator until the excess alcohol was removed and then the remaining residue was taken up in ethyl acetate and additional water was added. The organic phase was washed with saturated aqueous NaCl and dried over MgSO4. The solution was stripped free of solvent on a rotary evaporator, and the crude product residue was then further purified by chromatography.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=7.35-7.3 (m 5H), 6.8-6.7 (m 3H) 6.60 (d 1H, 7 Hz), 5.55 (d 1H 7.1 Hz), 3.9 (m 2H), 3.60 (s 2H), 1.85 (m 1H 7 Hz), 0.8 (q 6H 7 Hz)
13C-nmr (CDCl3): δ=171.3, 169.3, 165.4, 138.5, 137.0, 129.5, 129.2, 127.6, 113.1, 113.0, 112.8, 112.7, 103.8, 103.5, 103.2, 75.5, 57.2, 43.4, 43.3, 28.2, 19.3
C20H21NO3F2 (MW=361.39, Mass Spectroscopy (MH+362)).
Example A77 Synthesis of N-(cyclopentylacetyl)-L-phenylglycine methyl ester
Following General Procedure D′ above, and using cyclopentylacetic acid (Aldrich) with L-phenylglycine methyl ester hydrochloride (Bachem) the title compound was prepared.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=7.35 (s, 5H), 6.44 (bd, 1H), 5.6 (d, 1H), 3.72 (s, 3H), 2.24 (bs, 3H), 1.9-1.4 (m, 6H), 1.2-1.05 (m, 2H)
13C-nmr (CDCl3): δ=172.3, 171.7, 136.7, 129.0, 128.6, 127.3, 56.2, 52.7, 42.5, 36.9, 32.40, 32.38, 24.8
Example A78 Synthesis of N-(cyclopentylacetyl)-L-alanine methyl ester
Following General Procedure D′ above, and using cyclopentylacetic acid (Aldrich) with L-alanine methyl ester hydrochloride (Sigma) the title compound was prepared.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=6.38 (d, 1H), 4.50 (m, 1H), 3.65 (s, 3H), 2.13 (bs, 3H), 1.80-1.00 (m (includes d at 1.30, 3H), 11H)
3C-nmr (CDCl3): δ=173.7, 172.5, 52.1, 47.6, 42.3, 36.8, 32.15, 32.14, 18.0
C11H19NO3 (MW=213.28, Mass Spectroscopy (MH+ 214)).
Example A79 Synthesis of N-(cyclopropylacetyl)-L-phenylglycine methyl ester
Following General Procedure D′ above, and using cyclopropylacetic acid (Aldrich) with L-phenylglycine methyl ester hydrochloride (Bachem), the title compound was prepared.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=7.35 (m, 5H) 6.97 (bd, J=7.2 Hz, 1H) 5.59 (d, J=7.8 Hz, 1H), 3.71 (s, 3H), 2.17 (m, 2H), 1.05-0.95 (m, 1H), 0.62 (m, 2H), 0.02 (m, 2H)
13C-nmr (CDCl3): δ=171.9, 174.6, 136.6, 129.0, 128.5, 127.2, 56.1, 52.7, 41.0, 6.9, 4.37, 4.33
Example A80 Synthesis of N-(cyclopropylacetyl)-L-alanine methyl ester
Following General Procedure D′ above, and using cyclopropylacetic acid (Aldrich) with L-alanine methyl ester hydrochloride (Sigma), the title compound was prepared.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=6.60 (d, 1H), 4.55 (m, 1H), 3.69 (s, 3H), 2.10 (m, 2H), 1.34 (d, 3H), 0.95 (m, 1H), 0.58 (m, 2H) 0.15 (m, 2H)
13C-nmr (CDCl3): δ=173.7, 172.3, 52.3, 47.7, 41.0, 18.2, 6.7, 4.27, 4.22
Example A81 Synthesis of N-[(3-nitrophenyl)acetyl]-L-methionine iso-butyl ester
Following General Procedure H′ above, and using nitrophenylacetic acid (Aldrich) and L-methionine (Aldrich), the title compound was prepared as a tan oil. The reaction was monitored by tlc on silica gel.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=8.16 (m, 2H) 7.67 (d, 1H) 7.32 (t, 1H), 6.31 (bd, 1H), 4.69 (m, 1H), 3.90 (d, 2H), 3.68 (s, 2H), 2.47 (t, 2H), 2.15 (m, 1H), 2.02 (s, 3H), 1.90 (m, 2H), 0.91 (d, 6H).
C17H24N2O5S (MW=368.4, Mass Spectroscopy (M+ 368)).
The following General Procedures A″-B″ and Examples B1-B2 illustrate an alternative synthesis for N-(aryl/heteroarylacetyl)amino acids useful as starting materials for the preparation of the amides of this invention.
GENERAL PROCEDURE A″ Acid Chloride Preparation
3,5-Difluorophenylacetic acid (30 g, 0.174 mol) (Aldrich) was dissolved in dichloromethane and this solution was cooled to 0° C. DMF (0.5 mL, catalytic) was added followed by the dropwise addition of oxalyl chloride (18 mL, 0.20 mol) over a 5 minute period. The reaction was stirred for 3 h and then rotoevaporated at reduced pressure to a residue which was placed on a high vacuum pump for 1 h to afford 3,5-difluorophenylacetyl chloride as a thin yellow oil. Other acid chlorides can be prepared in a similar manner.
GENERAL PROCEDURE B″ Schotten-Bauman Procedure
3,5-Difluorophenylacetyl chloride (from General Procedure A″) was added dropwise to a 0° C. solution of L-alanine (Aldrich) (16.7 g, 0.187 mol) in 2 N sodium hydroxide (215 mL, 0.43 mol). The reaction was stirred for 1 h at 0° C. and then overnight at room temperature. The reaction was diluted with water (100 mL), then extracted with ethyl acetate (3×150 mL). The organic layer was then washed with brine (200 mL), dried over MgSO4, and rotoevaporated at reduced pressure to a residue. Recrystallization of the residue from ethyl acetate/hexanes afforded the desired product (34.5 g, 82% yield). Other acid chlorides may be used in this procedure to provide for intermediates useful in this invention.
Example B1 Synthesis of N-(Phenylacetyl)-L-alanine
Following General Procedure B″ above, title compound was prepared from phenylacetyl chloride (Aldrich) and L-alanine (Aldrich) as a solid having a melting point of 102-104° C.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=9.14 (br s, 1H), 7.21-7.40 (m, 5H), 6.20 (d, J=7.0 Hz, 1H), 4.55 (m, 1H), 3.61 (s, 2H), 1.37 (d, J=7.1 Hz, 3H).
13C-nmr (CDCl3): δ=176.0, 171.8, 134.0, 129.4, 127.5, 48.3, 43.2, 17.9.
Example B2 Synthesis of N-(3,5-Difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alanine
Following General Procedure B″ above, the title compound was prepared from 3,5-difluorophenylacetyl chloride (from General Procedure A″ above) and L-alanine (Aldrich).
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CD3OD): δ=8.32 (br s, 0.3H), 6.71 (m, 2H), 6.60 (m, 1H), 4.74 (br s, 1.7H), 4.16 (m, 1H), 3.36 (s, 2H), 1.19 (d, J=7.3 Hz, 3H).
13C-nmr (CD3OD): δ=175.9, 172.4, 164.4 (dd, J=13.0, 245.3 Hz), 141.1, 113.1 (dd, J 7.8, 17.1 Hz), 102.9 (t, J=25.7 Hz), 49.5, 42.7, 17.5.
The compounds set forth in Examples 1-22 were prepared by one of the following General Procedures A-G, unless otherwise indicated.
GENERAL PROCEDURE A EDC Coupling Procedure I
To a 1:1 mixture of the corresponding carboxylic acid and amino ester/amide in CH2Cl2 at 0° C. was added 1.5 equivalents triethylamine, followed by 2.0 equivalents hydroxybenzotriazole monohydrate, then 1.25 equivalents of 1-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-3-ethylcarbodiimide hydrochloride (EDC). The reaction mixture was stirred overnight at room temperature and then transferred to a separatory funnel. The mixture was washed with water, saturated aqueous NaHCO3, 1 N aqueous hydrochloric acid, and saturated aqueous sodium chloride, and then dried over MgSO4. The solution was stripped free of solvent on a rotary evaporator to yield the crude product.
GENERAL PROCEDURE B EDC Coupling Procedure II
A round-bottomed flask was charged with the appropriate carboxylic acid (1.0 eq.), hydroxybenzotriazole hydrate (1.1 eq.) and the appropriate amine (1.0 eq.) in THF under a nitrogen atmosphere. An appropriate amount (1.1 eq. for the free amine and 2.2 eq. for amine hydrochloride salt) of a suitable base, such as Hunig's base was added to the stirred mixture, followed by 1-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-3-ethylcarbodiimide hydrochloride (EDC) (1.1 eq). After stirring for about 4 hours to 17 hours at room temperature, the solvent was removed at reduced pressure and the residue taken up in EtOAc (or a similar solvent)/H2O. The extracts were washed with saturated NaHCO3, 1 N aqueous hydrochloric acid, brine and dried over Na2SO4. In some cases, the isolated product required further purification using standard procedures, such as chromatography and/or recrystallization.
GENERAL PROCEDURE C EDC Coupling Procedure III
A mixture of the appropriate carboxylic acid (1 eq.), 1-hydroxybenzotriazole (1.6 eq.), the appropriate amine (1 eq.), N-methylmorpholine (3 eq.) and dichloromethane (or DMF for insoluble substrates), cooled in an ice-water bath, was stirred until a clear solution was obtained. EDC (1.3 eq.) was added to the reaction mixture and the cooling bath was allowed to warm to ambient temperature over 1-2 h. The reaction was then stirred overnight. The reaction mixture was then evaporated to dryness under vacuum and 20% aqueous potassium carbonate was added to the residue. The mixture was shaken vigorously and allowed to stand for hours or overnight, if necessary, until the oily product to solidify. The solidified product was then filtered off, washed thoroughly with 20% potassium carbonate, water, 10% HCl, and water to give the product. No racemization was observed using this procedure.
GENERAL PROCEDURE D CDI Coupling Procedure I
A solution of the appropriate acid (3.3 mmol) and 1,1′-carbodiimidazole (CDI) in 20 mL THF was stirred for 2 hours. The amino acid ester hydrochloride (3.6 mmol) was added, followed by 1.5 mL (10.8 mmol) of triethylamine. The reaction mixture was stirred overnight and then dissolved in 100 mL of diethyl ether, washed with 10% HCl three times, brine once, 20% potassium carbonate once and brine once. The solution was dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered, and evaporated to yield the product.
GENERAL PROCEDURE E
CDI Coupling Reactions II
A solution of the acid (1.08 mmol) and 1,1′-carbodiimidazole (CDI, 0.972 mmol) in 10 ml THF was stirred for 1-2 hours. The appropriate amine (1.188 mmol) was added, and the reaction mixture was stirred overnight. The whole reaction mixture was dissolved in 100 ml of ethyl acetate, washed with 10% HCl (50×2 ml), brine once, 20% potassium carbonate once and brine once. The solution was dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered, and evaporated to yield the product.
GENERAL PROCEDURE F EDC Coupling Procedure IV
A round-bottomed flask was charged with the appropriate carboxylic acid (1.0 eq), hydroxybenzotriazole hydrate (1.1 eq) and the appropriate amine (1.0 eq) in THF under a nitrogen atmosphere. An appropriate amount (1.1 eq. for the free amine and 2.2 eq. for amine hydrochloride salt) of a suitable base, such as Hunig's base, was added to the stirred mixture, followed by 1-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-3-ethylcarbodiimide hydrochloride (EDC) (1.1 eq). After stirring for about 4 h to 17 h at room temperature, the solvent was removed at reduced pressure and the residue taken up in EtOAc (or a similar solvent)/H2O. The extracts were washed with saturated NaHCO3, 1 N aqueous hydrochloric acid, brine and dried over Na2SO4. In some cases, the isolated product required further purification using standard procedures, such as chromatography and/or recrystallization.
Example A Synthesis of 2-Amino-1-phthalimidopentane Hydrochloride
2-Amino-1-pentanol was stirred in a mixture of chloroform and saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate. Di-tert-butyl dicarbonate (1.05 eq.) was added in one portion and the mixture was stirred until starting material was consumed. The organic portion was separated, dried (sodium sulfate) and concentrated. The crude material was purified by silica gel chromatography using 1:1 ethyl acetate/hexanes.
The product was dissolved in THF. Triethylamine (1.1 eq.) was added and the mixture was cooled in an ice bath. Methanesulfonyl chloride (1.1 eq.) was added dropwise and the mixture was stirred until starting material was consumed. The mixture was concentrated under reduced pressure then was partitioned between ethyl acetate and water. The organic portion was separated, dried (sodium sulfate) and concentrated to yield a white solid which was chromatographed on silica gel using 30% ethyl acetate in hexanes and finally crystallized from 1-chlorobutane/hexanes.
The crystalline product was stirred in dry DMF and potassium phthalimide (1.1 eq.) was added. The mixture was stirred for 18 h then was concentrated under reduced pressure. The residue was partitioned between ethyl acetate and water. The organic portion was dried and concentrated to yield a white solid. The solid was taken up in chloroform and filtered through a plug of silica. Eluent containing product was concentrated to yield the crude product as a white solid.
The white solid was taken up in dry dioxane and the resulting solution was saturated with gaseous HCl. After stirring for 30 minutes, the mixture was concentrated to yield a white solid which was titrated in ether. The title compound was collected, washed with ether and dried in a vacuum oven.
Example B Synthesis of 5-Aminodibenzosuberane
5-Chlorodibenzosuberane (Aldrich) was heated at reflux in 7N NH3 in MeOH. After 18 hours, the reaction mixture was concentrated to a solid which was purified by silica gel chromatography to yield the title compound.
Example 1 Synthesis of N-(3-Hydroxyphenyl)-N′-(phenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide
Following General Procedure C and using N-(phenylacetyl)-L-alanine (Example B1) and 3-hydroxyaniline (Aldrich), the title compound was prepared as a solid (mp=164-167° C.). The product was purified by extraction with EtOAc and washing with aqueous NaHCO3 and HCl.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (DMSO-d6): δ=9.90 (s, 1H), 9.40 (s, 1H), 8.41 (d, J=7.4 Hz, 1H), 7.27 (m, 4H), 7.20 (m, 2H), 7.07 (t, J=8.0 Hz, 1H), 6.98 (m, 1H), 6.46 (dd, J=1.7, 7.1 Hz, 1H), 4.43 (m, 1H), 3.50 (s, 2H), 1.30 (d, J=7.1 Hz, 3H).
13C-nmr (DMSO-d6): δ=171.2, 170.0, 157.6, 140.0, 136.4, 129.4, 129.1, 128.2, 126.3, 110.5, 110.0, 106.4, 49.1, 41.9, 18.4.
C17H18N2O3 (MW=298.34); mass spectroscopy (MH+) 297 (M−H)+.
Example 2 Synthesis of N-(3-Methoxyphenyl)-N′-(phenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide
Following General Procedure E and using N-(phenylacetyl)-L-alanine (Example B1) and 3-methoxyaniline (Aldrich), the title compound was prepared as a solid (mp=154-157° C.).
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=9.38 (s, 1H), 7.20-7.35 (m, 6H), 7.00-7.15 (m, 2H), 6.91 (d, J=8.2 Hz, 1H), 6.62 (dd, J=2.2, 8.1 Hz, 1H), 4.85 (quint., J=7.2 Hz, 1H), 3.70 (s, 3H), 3.57 (s, 2H), 1.42 (d, J=7.0 Hz, 3H).
13C-nmr (CDCl3): δ=171.6, 171.0, 159.9, 139.1, 134.4, 129.5, 129.2, 128.8, 127.2, 112.2, 110.1, 105.5, 55.1, 49.8, 43.3, 18.5.
C18H20N2O3 (MW=312.37); mass spectroscopy (MH+) 313.
Example 3 Synthesis of N-(3-Ethoxycarbonylphenyl)-N′-(phenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide
Following General Procedure E and using N-(phenylacetyl)-L-alanine (Example B1) and ethyl 3-aminobenzoate (Aldrich), the title compound was prepared as a solid (mp=142-145° C.).
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=9.44 (s, 1H), 8.16 (d, J=1.8 Hz, 1H), 7.74 (dd, J=5.0, 8.0 Hz, 2H), 7.21-7.36 (m, 6H), 6.71 (d, J=7.6 Hz, 1H), 4.86 (m, 1H), 4.35 (q, J=7.1 Hz, 2H), 3.65 (s, 2H), 1.42 (d, J=7.0 Hz, 3H), 1.35 (t, J=7.8 Hz, 3H).
13C-nmr (CDCl3): δ=171.5, 170.8, 166.2, 138.2, 134.2, 131.0, 129.2, 129.0, 128.9, 127.4, 125.2, 124.2, 120.7, 61.1, 49.7, 43.5, 18.5, 14.3.
C20H22N2O4 (MW=354.41); mass spectroscopy (MH+) 355.
Example 4 Synthesis of N-(4-Ethoxycarbonylphenyl)-N′-(phenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide
Following General Procedure E and using N-(phenylacetyl)-L-alanine (Example B1) and ethyl 4-aminobenzoate (Aldrich), the title compound was prepared as a solid (mp=175-178° C.).
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=9.61 (s, 1H), 7.91 (dd, J=7.1, 8.9 Hz, 2H), 7.50 (dd, J=5.2, 8.7 Hz, 2H), 7.21-7.38 (m, 5H), 6.86 (d, J=7.6 Hz, 1H), 4.88 (quint., J=7.1 Hz, 1H), 4.35 (q, J=7.1 Hz, 2H), 3.62 (s, 2H), 1.36-1.44 (m, 6H).
13C-nmr (CDCl3): δ=171.7, 171.0, 166.1, 142.1, 134.2, 130.5, 129.2, 128.9, 127.5, 125.7, 118.9, 60.8, 49.8, 43.3, 18.6, 14.3.
C20H22N2O4 (MW=354.41); mass spectroscopy (MH+) 353 (M−H)+.
Example 5 Synthesis of N-(n-Hexyl)-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide
Following General Procedure B and using N-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alanine (Example B2) and n-hexylamine (Aldrich), the title compound was prepared as an oil. The reaction was monitored by tlc (Rf=0.31 in 5% MeOH/CH2Cl2) and the product was purified by flash column chromatography using 5% MeOH/CH2Cl2 as the eluent.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=7.62 (d, 1H), 7.14 (t, 1H), 6.80-6.60 (m, 3H), 4.62 (p, 1H), 3.44 (s, 2H), 3.23-3.01 (m, 2H), 1.41 (m, 2H), 1.39 (d, 3H), 1.23 (m, 8H), 0.83 (t, 3H).
13C-nmr (CDCl3): δ=173.0, 170.3, 165.1, 165.0, 161.8, 161.7, 139.47, 139.3, 139.2, 112.8, 112.7, 112.6, 112.5, 103.3, 103.0, 102.6, 49.5, 42.9, 40.1, 31.9, 29.8, 27.0, 23.0, 19.4, 14.5.
C17H24N2O2F2 (MW=326.39); mass spectroscopy (MH+) 327.
Example 6 Synthesis of N-(n-Octyl)-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide
Following General Procedure B and using N-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alanine (Example B2) and n-octylamine (Aldrich), the title compound was prepared as an oil. The reaction was monitored by tlc (Rf=0.35 in 5% MeOH/CH2Cl2) and the product was purified by flash column chromatography using 5% MeOH/CH2Cl2 as the eluent.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=7.50 (d, 1H), 7.03 (t, 1H), 6.75-6.60 (m, 5H), 4.60 (p, 1H), 3.48 (s, 2H), 3.24-3.04 (m, 2H), 1.40 (m, 2H), 1.38 (d, 3H), 1.23 (m, 10H), 0.86 (t, 3H).
13C-nmr (CDCl3): δ=172.9, 170.2, 165.2, 165.0, 161.9, 161.7, 139.3, 139.2, 139.1, 112.8, 112.7, 112.6, 112.5, 103.4, 103.0, 102.7, 49.5, 43.0, 40.1, 32.3, 29.9, 29.7, 27.4, 23.1, 19.4, 14.6.
C19H28N2O2F2 (MW=354.44); mass spectroscopy (MH+) 355.
Example 7 Synthesis of N-(3-Methoxyphenyl)-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide
Following General Procedure E and using N-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alanine (Example B2) and 3-methoxyaniline (Aldrich), the title compound was prepared.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (DMSO-d6): δ=1.30 (d, J=7.0 Hz, 3H), 3.54 (s, 2H), 3.71 (s, 3H), 4.40 (quint., J=7.0 Hz, 1H), 6.62 (d, J=6.7 Hz, 1H), 6.96-7.26 (m, 5H), 7.29 (s, 1H), 8.51 (d, J=7.1 Hz, 1H), 10.04 (s, 1H).
13C-nmr (DMSO-d6): δ=18.2, 41.2, 49.2, 54.9, 101.9 (t, J=25.5 Hz), 104.9, 108.7, 111.4, 112.2 (dd, J=7.3, 17.0 Hz), 129.5, 140.1, 140.7, 159.5, 162.1 (m), 168.9, 171.3.
C18H18N2O3F2 (MW=348.35); mass spectroscopy (MH+) 349.
Example 8 Synthesis of N-(4-Ethoxycarbonylphenyl)-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide
Following General Procedure E and using N-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alanine (Example B2) and ethyl 4-aminobenzoate (Aldrich), the title compound was prepared.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (DMSO-d6): δ=1.32 (m, 6H), 3.55 (s, 2H), 4.27 (q, J=7.0 Hz, 2H), 4.42 (quint., J=7.0 Hz, 1H), 7.00 (m, 2H), 7.08 (m, 1H), 7.73 (d, J=8.5 Hz, 2H), 7.91 (d, J=8.7 Hz, 2H), 8.57 (d, J=6.7 Hz, 1H), 10.40 (s, 1H).
13C-nmr (DMSO-d6): δ=14.2, 17.9, 41.1, 49.4, 60.5, 101.9 (t, J=25.3 Hz), 112.2 (dd, J=7.4, 16.9 Hz), 118.6, 124.3, 130.3, 140.6, 140.8, 143.3, 162.1 (dd, J=13.1, 243.7 Hz), 165.3, 169.0, 171.9.
C20H20N2O4F2 (MW=390.39); mass spectroscopy (MH+) 391.
Example 9 Synthesis of N-(3-Ethoxycarbonylphenyl)-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide
Following General Procedure E and using N-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alanine (Example B2) and ethyl 3-aminobenzoate (Aldrich), the title compound was prepared.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=1.34 (t, J=7.1 Hz, 3H), 1.47 (d, J=6.9 Hz, 3H), 3.57 (s, 2H), 4.33 (q, J=7.1 Hz, 2H), 4.85 (quint, J=7.1 Hz, 1H), 6.66 (m, 1H), 6.78 (m, 2H), 7.16 (d, J=7.4 Hz, 1H), 7.30 (m, 1H), 7.74 (t, J=7.8 Hz, 2H), 8.12 (d, J=1.8 Hz, 1H), 9.38 (s, 1H).
13C-nmr (CDCl3): δ=14.2, 18.6, 42.7, 49.9, 61.2, 102.8 (t, J=25.1 Hz), 112.2 (dd, J=8.0, 17.1 Hz), 120.9, 124.3, 125.4, 129.0, 131.1, 137.9, 138.0, 163.0 (dd, J=12.6, 247.7 Hz), 166.2, 170.2, 171.0.
C20H20N2O4F2 (MW=390.39); mass spectroscopy (MH+) 391.
Example 10 Synthesis of N-(3-Chlorophenyl)-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide
Following General Procedure E and using N-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alanine (Example B2) and 3-chloroaniline (Aldrich), the title compound was prepared.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (DMSO-d6): δ=1.31 (d, J=7.1 Hz, 3H), 3.55 (s, 2H), 4.38 (quint, J=7.1 Hz, 1H), 7.00 (m, 2H), 7.09 (m, 2H), 7.33 (m, 1H), 7.46 (d, J=8.2 Hz, 1H), 7.80 (s, 1H), 8.57 (d, 7.0 Hz, 1H), 10.26 (s, 1H).
13C-nmr (DMSO-d6): δ=18.0, 41.2, 49.3, 101.9 (t, J=25.5 Hz), 112.2 (dd, J=7.3, 16.7 Hz), 117.6, 118.6, 123.0, 130.5, 133.1, 140.4, 140.5, 140.7, 162.2 (m), 169.0, 171.7.
C17H15N2O2F2Cl (MW=352.77); mass spectroscopy (MH+) 353.
Example 11 Synthesis of N-(3,5-Dichlorophenyl)-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide
Following General Procedure E and using N-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alanine (Example B2) and 3,5-dichloroaniline (Aldrich), the title compound was prepared.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (DMSO-d6): δ=1.31 (d, J=7.0 Hz, 3H), 3.55 (s, 2H), 4.34 (m, 1H), 7.00 (m, 2H), 7.07 (m, 1H), 7.27 (s, 1H), 7.66 (s, 2H), 8.59 (d, J=6.6 Hz, 1H), 10.39 (s, 1H).
13C-nmr (DMSO-d6): δ=17.7, 41.1, 49.5, 101.9 (t, J=25.5 Hz), 112.3 (dd, J=7.7, 16.9 Hz), 117.3, 122.6, 134.1, 140.4, 140.6, 140.7, 141.2, 162.1 (dd, J=13.4, 243.9 Hz), 169.1, 172.0.
C17H14N2O2F2Cl2 (MW=387.22); mass spectroscopy (MH+) 387.
Example 12 Synthesis of N-(3-Cyanophenyl)-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide
Following General Procedure E and using N-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alanine (Example B2) and 3-cyanoaniline (Aldrich), the title compound was prepared.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (DMSO-d6): δ=1.32 (t, J=7.1 Hz, 3H), 3.55 (s, 2H), 4.39 (quint, J=7.0 Hz, 1H), 7.00 (m, 2H), 7.08 (m, 1H), 7.52 (m, 2H), 7.82 (m, 1H), 8.08 (s, 1H), 8.60 (d, J=6.8 Hz, 1H), 10.42 (s, 1H).
13C-nmr (DMSO-d6): δ=17.9, 41.1, 49.4, 101.9 (t, J=25.4 Hz), 112.2 (dd, J=7.7, 17.0 Hz), 118.7, 121.8, 123.7, 126.9, 130.3, 139.7, 140.6, 140.8, 162.1 (dd, J=13.3, 243.6 Hz), 169.1, 172.0.
C18H15N3O2F2 (MW=343.34); mass spectroscopy (MH+) 344.
Example 13 Synthesis of N-(Phthalid-6yl)-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide
Following General Procedure E and using N-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alanine (Example B2) and 6-aminophthalide (Aldrich), the title compound was prepared as a solid (mp=241-245 (decomp)° C.). The reaction was monitored by tlc (Rf=0.11 in 1:1 EtOAc/hexanes) and the product was purified by precipitation from water.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (DMSO-d6): δ=1.34 (d, J=7.1 Hz, 3H), 3.56 (s, 2H), 4.42 (m, 1H), 5.36 (s, 2H), 7.00 (d, J=6.9 Hz, 2H), 7.08 (m, 1H), 7.62 (d, J=8.4 Hz, 1H), 7.81 (m, 1H), 8.21 (s, 1H), 8.59 (d, J=6.8 Hz, 1H), 10.42 (s, 1H).
13C-nmr (DMSO-d6): δ=18.0, 41.2, 49.3, 69.8, 101.9 (t, J=25.7 Hz), 112.3 (dd, J=7.4, 16.9 Hz), 114.2, 123.4, 125.3, 125.5, 139.7, 140.6, 141.9, 162.1 (dd, J=13.4, 243.7 Hz), 169.1, 170.8, 171.8.
C19H16N2O4F2 (MW=374.35); mass spectroscopy (MH+) 375.
Example 14 Synthesis of N-[(4-Methoxycarbonylphenyl)methyl]-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide
Following General Procedure D and using N-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alanine (Example B2) and methyl 4-aminomethylbenzoate HCl(Aldrich), the title compound was prepared as a solid (mp=191-192° C.). The reaction was monitored by tlc (Rf=0.19 in 1:1 EtOAc/hexanes) and the product was purified by precipitation from water.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (DMSO-d6): δ=1.25 (d, J=7.0 Hz, 3H), 3.53 (s, 2H), 3.84 (s, 3H), 4.30 (m, 1H), 4.35 (d, J=6.0 Hz, 2H), 6.99 (d, J=6.9 Hz, 2H), 7.08 (t, J=2.1 Hz, 1H), 7.35 (d, J=8.3 Hz, 2H), 7.88 (d, J=8.2 Hz, 2H), 8.43 (d, J=7.2 Hz, 1H), 8.57 (t, 5.9 Hz, 1H).
13C-nmr (DMSO-d6): δ=18.2, 41.3, 41.7, 48.5, 52.1, 101.9 (t, 25.4 Hz), 112.2 (dd, J=7.5, 17.0 Hz), 127.1, 128.1, 129.2, (140.6, 140.8 as multiplet), 145.2, 162.1 (dd, J=13.4, 243.7 Hz), 166.1, 168.9, 172.5.
C20H20N2O4F2 (MW=390.39); mass spectroscopy (MH+) 391.
Example 15 Synthesis of N-(1-Cyano-1-phenylmethyl)-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide
Following General Procedure B and using N-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alanine (Example B2) and 1-cyano-1-phenylmethylamine hydrochloride, the title compound was prepared as a solid (mp=209-213° C.). The reaction was monitored by tlc (Rf=0.5 in 10% MeOH/CHCl3) and the product was purified by recrystallization from 1-chlorobutane/acetonitrile.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (DMSO-d6): δ=3.50-3.55 (singlets, 2H); 6.18 (d, 1H).
C19H17F2N3O2 (MW=357.36); mass spectroscopy (M+) 357.
Example 16 Synthesis of N-[(S)-1-Phenylethyl]-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide
Following General Procedure B and using N-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alanine (Example B2) and (S)-(−)-1-phenylethylamine (Aldrich), the title compound was prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc (Rf=0.45 in 9:1 CHCl3/MeOH) and the product was purified by silica gel chromatography using 95:5 CHCl3/MeOH as the eluent.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=7.18-7.28 (m, 5H), 6.81 (m, 1H), 6.67 (m, 2H), 6.63 (m, 1H), 6.60 (m, 1H), 5.01 (m, 1H), 4.44 (m, 1H), 3.36 (m, 2H), 1.43 (d, 3H), 1.36 (d, 3H).
Optical Rotation: [α]23=−103° (c 1, MeOH).
C19H20F2N2O2 (MW=346.38); mass spectroscopy (M+) 346.
Example 17 Synthesis of N-[(R)-1-Phenylethyl]-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide
Following General Procedure B and using N-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alanine (Example B2) and (R)-(+)-1-phenylethylamine (Aldrich), the title compound was prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc (Rf=0.35 in 9:1 CHCl3/MeOH) and the product was purified by silica gel chromatography using 96:4 CHCl3/MeOH as the eluent.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=7.31 (m, 5H), 6.78 (m, 2H), 6.71 (m, 1H), 6.32 (m, 1H), 5.01 (m, 1H), 4.46 (m, 1H), 3.45 (m, 2H), 1.43 (d, 3H), 1.30 (d, 3H).
Optical Rotation: [α]23=+5.97° (c 1, MeOH).
C19H20F2N2O2 (MW=346.38); mass spectroscopy (M+) 346.
Example 18 Synthesis of N-[2-Methoxycarbonyl-1-phenylethyl]-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide
Following General Procedure B and using N-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alanine (Example B2) and methyl 3-amino-3-phenylpropionate hydrochloride, the title compound was prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc (Rf=0.45 in 9:1 CHCl3/MeOH) and the product was purified by silica gel chromatography using 95:5 CHCl3/MeOH as the eluent.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=7.28 (m, 5H), 6.89-6.67 (m, 2H), 6.37 (m, 1H), 5.36 (m, 1H), 4.52 (m, 1H), 3.63 and 3.60 s, 3H), 3.51 and 3.45 (s, 2H), 2.80 (m, 2H), 1.37 (t, 3H).
C21H22F2N2O4 (MW=404.41); mass spectroscopy (M+) 404.
Example 19 Synthesis of N-[2-Hydroxypyridin-3-yl]-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide
Following General Procedure C and using N-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alanine (Example B2) and 3-amino-2-hydroxypyridine (prepared by Pd/C hydrogenation of 2-hydroxy-3-nitropyrdine under standard conditions in EtOH/HOAc), the title compound was prepared.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (DMSO-d6): δ=1.28 (d, J=7 Hz, 3H), 3.55 (s, 2H), 4.51 (brq, J=7 Hz, 1H), 6.20 (t, J=7 Hz, 1H), 6.95-7.2 (m, 4H), 8.18 (dd, J=1.7, 7.3 Hz, 1H), 8.64 (d, J=7.0 Hz, 1H), 9.24 (s, 1H).
13C-nmr (DMSO-d6): δ=17.9, 41.5, 49.7, 102.0, 102.3, 102.6, 105.6, 112.5, 112.6, 112.8, 112.9, 123.4, 128.20, 112.21, 129.2, 140.8, 160.9, 164.0, 164.2, 169.6, 172.1.
C16H15F2N3O3 (MW=335).
Example 20 Synthesis of N-1-(Phthalimido)pent-2-yl-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide
Following General Procedure F and using N-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alanine (Example B2) and 2-amino-1-phthalimidopentane hydrochloride (from Example A above), the title compound was prepared. The reaction was monitored by tlc (Rf=0.3 in 5% MeOH/CHCl3) and the product was purified by silica gel chromatography using 5% MeOH/CHCl3 as the eluent, followed by recrystallization from chlorobutane/acetonitrile.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (DMSO-d6): δ=4.1 (m, 2H), 7.83 (bs, 4H).
C24H25N3O4F2 (MW=457.48); mass spectroscopy (MH+) 457.
Example 21 Synthesis of N-[α-pyridin-2-yl-benyzl]-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide
Following General Procedure F and using N-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alanine (Example B2) and α-(2-pyridyl)benzylamine (Maybridge) the title compound was prepared. The product was purified by silica gel chromatography using 5% MeOH/CHCl3 as the eluent, followed by recrystallization from n-chlorobutane/acetonitrile.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (DMSO-d6): δ=6.10 (d, 1H), 4.46 (m, 1H).
C23H21F2N3O2 (MW=409.44); mass spectroscopy (MH+) 409.
Example 22 Synthesis of N-[2-(methoxycarbonylmethyl)benzyl]-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide
2-(Aminomethyl)-benzeneacetate hydrochloride was stirred in dry methanol. Thionyl chloride (1.1 eq.) was added dropwise and the mixture was stirred at room temperature overnight to provide for (methyl 2-(aminomethyl)-benzeneacetate hydrochloride as a white solid.
N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alanine (Example B2) in dichloromethane was coupled to (methyl 2-(aminomethyl)-benzeneacetate hydrochloride using EDC, HOBT, DIEA to provide for the title compound.
MS (M+) 404.1
Example 23 Synthesis of N-[3-(methoxycarbonyl)benzyl]-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide
The title compound was prepared by following the procedure set forth in Example 22 but substituting (methyl 3-(aminomethyl)-benzeneacetate hydrochloride for (methyl 3-(aminomethyl)-benzoate hydrochloride.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=1.410 (d, 3H), 3.56 (s, 2H).
MS (M+) 390.
Example 24 Synthesis of N-[2-(2′-methoxycarbonylmethylphenyl)benzyl]-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide
The title compound was prepared by following the procedure set forth in Example 22 but substituting 2-(2′-methoxycarbonylmethylphenyl)benzyl amine for (methyl 3-(aminomethyl)-benzoate hydrochloride.
Example 25 Synthesis of N-[2-phenylbenzyl]-N′-(3,5difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide
The title compound was prepared by following the procedure set forth in Example 22 but substituting 2-phenylbenzylamine for (methyl 3-(aminomethyl)-benzoate hydrochloride.
NMR data was as follows:
1H-nmr (CDCl3): δ=1.22 (d, 3H), 3.46 (s, 2H).
MS (M+) 408.
Example 26 Cellular Screen for the Detection of Inhibitors of β-Amyloid Production
Numerous compounds of formula I above were assayed for their ability to inhibit β-amyloid production in a cell line possessing the Swedish mutation. This screening assay employed cells (K293=human kidney cell line) which were stably transfected with the gene for amyloid precursor protein 751 (APP751) containing the double mutation Lys651Met652to Asn651Leu652 (APP751 numbering) in the manner described in International patent application Publication No. 94/105698 and Citron et al.12. This mutation is commonly called the Swedish mutation and the cells, designated as “293 751 SWE”, were plated in Corning 96-well plates at 1.5-2.5×104 cells per well in Dulbecco's minimal essential media plus 10% fetal bovine serum. Cell number is important in order to achieve β-amyloid ELISA results within the linear range of the assay (˜0.2 to 2.5 ng per mL).
Following overnight incubation at 37° C. in an incubator equilibrated with 10% carbon dioxide, media were removed and replaced with 200 μL of a compound of formula I (drug) containing media per well for a two hour pretreatment period and cells were incubated as above. Drug stocks were prepared in 100% dimethylsulfoxide such that at the final drug concentration used in the treatment, the concentration of dimethylsulfoxide did not exceed 0.5% and, in fact, usually equaled 0.1%.
At the end of the pretreatment period, the media were again removed and replaced with fresh drug containing media as above and cells were incubated for an additional two hours. After treatment, plates were centrifuged in a Beckman GPR at 1200 rpm for five minutes at room temperature to pellet cellular debris from the conditioned media. From each well, 100 μL of conditioned media or appropriate dilutions thereof were transferred into an ELISA plate precoated with antibody 26614 against amino acids 13-28 of β-amyloid peptide as described in International Patent Application Publication No. 94/105698 and stored at 4° C. overnight. An ELISA assay employing labelled antibody 6C614 against amino acids 1-16 of β-amyloid peptide was run the next day to measure the amount of β-amyloid peptide produced.
Cytotoxic effects of the compounds were measured by a modification of the method of Hansen, et al.13. To the cells remaining in the tissue culture plate was added 25 μL of a 3,(4,5-dimethylthiazol-2-yl)2,5-diphenyltetrazolium bromide (MTT) stock solution (5 mg/mL) to a final concentration of 1 mg/ML. Cells were incubated at 37° C. for one hour, and cellular activity was stopped by the addition of an equal volume of MTT lysis buffer (20% w/v sodium dodecylsulfate in 50% dimethylformamide, pH 4.7). Complete extraction was achieved by overnight shaking at room temperature. The difference in the OD562nm and the OD650nm was measured in a Molecular Device's UVmax microplate reader as an indicator of the cellular viability.
The results of the β-amyloid peptide ELISA were fit to a standard curve and expressed as ng/mL β-amyloid peptide. In order to normalize for cytotoxicity, these results were divided by the MTT results and expressed as a percentage of the results from a drug free control. All results are the mean and standard deviation of at least six replicate assays.
The test compounds were assayed for β-amyloid peptide production inhibition activity in cells using this assay. The results of this assay demonstrate that, each of the compounds within this invention tested reduced β-amyloid peptide production by at least 30% as compared to control.
Example 27 In Vivo Suppression of β-Amyloid Release and/or Synthesis
This example illustrates how the compounds of this invention could be tested for in vivo suppression of β-amyloid release and/or synthesis. For these experiments, 3 to 4 month old PDAPP mice are used [Games et al., (1995) Nature 373:523-527]. Depending upon which compound is being tested, the compound is usually formulated at either 5 or 10 mg/ml. Because of the low solubility factors of the compounds, they may be formulated with various vehicles, such as corn oil (Safeway, South San Francisco, Calif.); 10% EtOH in corn oil (Safeway); 2-hydroxypropyl-β-cyclodextrin (Research Biochemicals International, Natick Mass.); and carboxy-methyl-cellulose (Sigma Chemical Co., St. Leuis Mo.). Specifically, for example 141 the vehicle was carboxy-methyl-cellulose (Sigma).
The mice are dosed subcutaneously with a 26 gauge needle and 3 hours later the animals are euthanized via CO2 narcosis and blood is taken by cardiac puncture using a 1 cc 25 G ⅝″ tuberculin syringe/needle coated with solution of 0.5 M EDTA, pH 8.0. The blood is placed in a Becton-Dickinson vacutainer tube containing EDTA and spun down for 15 minutes at 1500×g at 5° C. The brains of the mice are then removed and the cortex and hippocampus are dissected out and placed on ice.
1. Brain Assay
To prepare hippocampal and cortical tissue for enzyme-linked immunosorbent assays (ELISAs) each brain region is homogenized in 10 volumes of ice cold guanidine buffer (5.0 M guanidine-HCl, 50 mM Tris-HCl, pH 8.0) using a Kontes motorized pestle (Fisher, Pittsburgh Pa.). The homogenates are gently rocked on a rotating platform for three to four hours at room temperature and stored at −20° C. prior to quantitation of β-amyloid.
The brain homogenates are diluted 1:10 with ice-cold casein buffer [0.25% casein, phosphate buffered saline (PBS), 0.05% sodium azide, 20 μg/ml aprotinin, 5 mM EDTA, pH 8.0, 10 μg/ml leupeptin], thereby reducing the final concentration of guanidine to 0.5 M, before centrifugation at 16,000×g for 20 minutes at 4° C. The β-amyloid standards (1-40 or 1-42 amino acids) were prepared such that the final composition equaled 0.5 M guanidine in the presence of 0.1% bovine serum albumin (BSA).
The total β-amyloid sandwich ELISA, quantitating both β-amyloid (aa 1-40) and β-amyloid (aa 1-42) consists of two monoclonal antibodies (mAb) to β-amyloid. The capture antibody, 26614, is specific to amino acids 13-28 of β-amyloid. The antibody 3D615, which is specific to amino acids 1-5 of β-amyloid, is biotinylated and served as the reporter antibody in the assay. The 3D6 biotinylation procedure employs the manufacturer's (Pierce, Rockford Ill.) protocol for NHS-biotin labeling of immunoglobulins except that 100 mM sodium bicarbonate, pH 8.5 buffer is used. The 3D6 antibody does not recognize secreted amyloid precursor protein (APP) or full-length APP but detects only β-amyloid species with an amino terminal aspartic acid. The assay has a lower limit of sensitivity of ˜50 pg/ml (11 pM) and shows no cross-reactivity to the endogenous murine β-amyloid peptide at concentrations up to 1 ng/ml.
The configuration of the sandwich ELISA quantitating the level of β-amyloid (aa 1-42) employs the mAb 21F1215 (which recognizes amino acids 33-42 of β-amyloid) as the capture antibody. Biotinylated 3D6 is also the reporter antibody in this assay which has a lower limit of sensitivity of ˜125 pg/ml (28 pM).
The 266 and 21F12 capture mAbs are coated at 10 μg/ml into 96 well immunoassay plates (Costar, Cambidge Mass.) overnight at room temperature. The plates are then aspirated and blocked with 0.25% human serum albumin in PBS buffer for at least 1 hour at room temperature, then stored desiccated at 4° C. until use. The plates are rehydrated with wash buffer (Tris-buffered saline, 0.05% Tween 20) prior to use. The samples and standards are added to the plates and incubated overnight at 4° C. The plates are washed ≧3 times with wash buffer between each step of the assay. The biotinylated 3D6, diluted to 0.5 μg/ml in casein incubation buffer (0.25% casein, PBS, 0.05% Tween 20, pH 7.4) is incubated in the well for 1 hour at room temperature. Avidin-HRP (Vector, Burlingame Calif.) diluted 1:4000 in casein incubation buffer is added to the wells for 1 hour at room temperature. The calorimetric substrate, Slow TMB-ELISA (Pierce, Cambridge Mass.), is added and allowed to react for 15 minutes, after which the enzymatic reaction is stopped with addition of 2 N H2SO4. Reaction product is quantified using a Molecular Devices Vmax (Molecular Devices, Menlo Park Calif.) measuring the difference in absorbance at 450 nm and 650 nm.
2. Blood Assay
The EDTA plasma is diluted 1:1 in specimen diluent (0.2 gm/1 sodium phosphate.H2O (monobasic), 2.16 gm/1 sodium phosphate.7H2O (dibasic), 0.5gm/1 thimerosal, 8.5 gm/l sodium chloride, 0.5 ml TritonX-405, 6.0 g/l globulin-free bovine serum albumin; and water). The samples and standards in specimen diluent are assayed using the total β-amyloid assay (266 capture/3D6 reporter) described above for the brain assay except the specimen diluent was used instead of the casein diluents described.
From the foregoing description, various modifications and changes in the composition and method will occur to those skilled in the art. All such modifications coming within the scope of the appended claims are intended to be included therein.

Claims (44)

What is claimed is:
1. A pharmaceutical composition comprising a pharmaceutically inert carrier and a pharmaceutically effective amount of a compound of formula I:
Figure US06262302-20010717-C00010
wherein R1 is selected from the group consisting of
a) alkyl, alkenyl, alkaryl, alkcycloalkyl, aryl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, heteroaryl and heterocyclic wherein the heteroaryl or heterocyclic group is optionally substituted with 1 to 3 substituents selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, aryl, aryloxy, halo, nitro, thioalkoxy, and thioaryloxy;
(b) a substituted phenyl group of formula II:
Figure US06262302-20010717-C00011
wherein R is alkylene of from 1 to 8 carbon atoms,
m is an integer equal to 0 or 1,
Ra and Ra′ are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, hydroxy, fluoro and methyl;
Rb and Rb′ are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkoxy, aryl, aryloxy, cyano, cycloalkyl, halo, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heterocyclic, nitro, trihalomethyl, thioalkoxy, thioaryloxy, thioheteroaryloxy, and —C(O)R4 where R4 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, aryl, alkoxy and aryloxy; and
Rc is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, aryl, cyano, halo, nitro, and where Rb and Rc are fused to form a methylenedioxy ring with the phenyl ring; and
when Rb and/or Rb′ and/or Rc is fluoro, chloro, bromo and/or nitro, then Ra and/or Ra′ can also be chloro; and
(c) 1- or 2-naphthyl substituted at the 5, 6, 7 and/or 8 positions with 1 to 4 substituents selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halo, cyano, nitro, trihalomethyl, and thioalkoxy;
R2 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl of from 1 to 4 carbon atoms, alkylalkoxy of from 1 to 4 carbon atoms, alkylthioalkoxy of from 1 to 4 carbon atoms; and
R3 and R3′ are independently selected from the group consisting of:
(a) hydrogen with the proviso that both R3 and R3′ cannot be hydrogen;
(b) alkyl with the proviso that when R3 is hydrogen, then the R3′ alkyl group has a linear carbon chain length of at least 5 carbon atoms from the nitrogen atom which chain can be optionally substituted with one or more alkyl groups and with the further proviso that when both R3 and R3′ are alkyl then at least one of the alkyl group has a carbon chain length of at least 5 carbon atoms which chain can be optionally substituted with one or more alkyl groups;
(c) —(R7)n (W)p wherein R7 is an alkylene group, W is selected from the group consisting of:
(i)
Figure US06262302-20010717-C00012
where R5, R5′, R9 and R9′ are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, hydroxyl, alkyl, an alkyl group having 1 to 3 substituents selected from the group consisting of alkoxy, substituted alkoxy, acyl, acyloxy, acylamino, amino, aminoacyl, aminocarboxy esters, cyano, cycloalkyl, halogen, hydroxyl, carboxyl, carboxyl esters, thio, thioalkoxy, substituted thioalkoxy, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclic, nitro, and mono- and di-(substituted alkyl)amino, mono- and di-arylamino, mono- and di-heterocyclic amino, mono- and di-heteroaryl amino and unsymmetric di-substituted amines having different substituents selected from alkyl, substituted alkyl, aryl, heteroayl, and heterocyclic provided that when the substituent is monoheteroarylamino or unsymmetric di-substituted amines having different substituents selected from alkyl and heteroaryl then the heteroaryl ring is monocyclic, alkoxy, substituted alkoxy, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, aryl, acyl, acylamino, acyloxy, aminoacyl, cyano, cycloalkyl,halogen, carboxyl, carboxyl esters, heteroaryl and heterocyclic; and
R6 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, hydroxyl, alkyl, an alkyl group having 1 to 3 substituents selected from the group consisting of alkoxy, substituted alkoxy, acyl, acyloxy, acylamino, amino, aminoacyl, aminocarboxy esters, cyano, cycloalkyl, halogen, hydroxyl, carboxyl, carboxyl esters, thio, thioalkoxy, substituted thioalkoxy, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclic, nitro, and mono- and di-(substituted alkyl)amino, mono- and di-arylamino, mono- and di-heterocyclic amino, mono- and di-heteroaryl amino and unsymmetric di-substituted amines having different substituents selected from alkyl, substituted alkyl, aryl, heteroayl, and heterocyclic provided that when the substituent is monoheteroarylamino or unsymmetric di-substituted amines having different substituents selected from alkyl and heteroaryl then the heteroaryl ring is monocyclic, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, aryl, acyl, acylamino, acyloxy, alkoxy, substituted alkoxy, aminoacyl, cyano, cycloalkyl, halogen, carboxyl, carboxyl esters, heteroaryl, heterocyclic and where R6 and one of R5 or R5′ are fused to from a heterocyclic ring of from 4 to 10 atoms having from 1 to 3 heteroatoms selected from the group consisting of oxygen, nitrogen and sulfur;
with the proviso that when n is zero, R9 and R9′ are hydrogen;
(ii) heteroaryl; and
(iii) N-heterocyclic with the proviso that when W is N-heterocyclic then n is not zero; and
n is an integer equal to 0 or 1, and
p is an integer equal to 1 to 3 with the proviso that when n is zero then p is equal to 1, and
(d) —CH(φ)CH2C(O)O—Q where Q is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, aryl, heteroaryl and heterocyclic
X′ is hydrogen, hydroxy or fluoro;
X″ is hydrogen, hydroxy or fluoro, or X′ and X″ together form an oxo group,
Z is selected from the group consisting of a bond covalently linking R1 to —CX′X″—, oxygen and sulfur; and
with the proviso that when R1 is phenyl, R2 is methyl, X′ and X″ are hydrogen, Z is a group covalently linking R1 to —CX′X″—, m is zero, R3 is hydrogen, R3′ is —(R7)n (W)p where n is zero and p is one and W is
Figure US06262302-20010717-C00013
then (i) R5, R5′, R9, R9′ and R6 are not all hydrogen and (ii) R5, R5′, R9, R9′ are hydrogen and R6 is methoxy;
with the further proviso that when R1 is 3,5-difluorophenyl, R2 is methyl, X′ and X″ are hydrogen, Z is a group covalently linking R1 to —CX′X″—, m is zero, R3 is hydrogen, R3′ is —(R7)n (W)p where n is one and p is one, R7 is ethylene and W is
Figure US06262302-20010717-C00014
then R5, R5′, R9, R9′ and R6 are not all hydrogen;
with still the further proviso that when R1 is 3,5-difluorophenyl, R2 is methyl, X′ and X″ are hydrogen, Z is a group covalently linking R1 to —CX′X″—, and m is zero, R3 is hydrogen, R3′ is —(R7)n (W)p where n is zero and p is one, W is
Figure US06262302-20010717-C00015
and R5′, R9, R9′ are hydrogen, then R5 and R6 are not fused to form, with the phenyl ring to which they are attached, a phthalimido groups;
with still further proviso that when Z is a group covalently linking R1 to —CX′X″—, X′ and X″ are hydrogen, R2 is alkyl of from 1 to 4 carbon atoms or alkylthioalkoxy of from 1 to 4 carbon atoms, R3 is hydrogen, and R3′ is —(R7)n (W)p where n is zero and f is one and W is
Figure US06262302-20010717-C00016
wherein one of R5, R5′, R6, R9 and R9′ is a carboxyl ester, halogen, or alkoxy, or R5 and R6 form methylenedioxy, then R1 is not alkyl or alkyl substituted with halogen;
with still further proviso that when R1 is alkyl, Z is a group covalently linking R1 to —CX′X″—, X′ and X″ are hydrogen, R3 is hydrogen, and R3′ is —(R7)n (W)p where n is zero and p is one and W is
Figure US06262302-20010717-C00017
then R5, R5′, R9, R9′ and R6 are not all hydrogen; and
with still further proviso that when R1 is phenyl, Z is a group covalently linking R1 to —CX′X″—, X′ and X″ are hydrogen, R3 is hydrogen, then R3′ is —(R7)n (W)p where R7 is methylene then W is not pyridyl or furfural.
2. The pharmaceutical composition according to claim 1 wherein R1 is an unsubstituted aryl group.
3. The pharmaceutical composition according to claim 2 wherein the unsubstituted R1 aryl group is selected from the group consisting of phenyl, 1-naphthyl and 2-naphthyl.
4. The pharmaceutical composition according to claim 1 wherein R1 is a substituted aryl group.
5. The pharmaceutical composition according to claim 4 wherein the substituted aryl groups are substituted phenyl groups defined by the following:
(a) monosubstituted phenyls having a single substitution at the 2, 3 or 4 positions wherein each of the particular subsituents is governed by the respective Ra, Rb and Rc groups;
(b) disubstituted phenyls having two substituents at the 2,3-positions, 2,4-positions, 2,5-positions, 2,6-positions, 3,4-positions, 3,5-positions or 3,6-positions wherein each of these substituents is governed by the respective Ra, Ra′, Rb, Rb′ and Rc groups; and
(c) trisubstituted phenyls having three substituents at the 2,3,4-positions, 2,3,5-positions, 2,3,6-positions, 3,4,5-positions and 3,4,6-positions wherein each of these substituents is governed by the respective Ra, Ra′, Rb, Rb′ and Rc groups.
6. The pharmaceutical composition according to claim 5 wherein the substituted phenyl groups are selected from the group consisting of 4-fluorophenyl, 4-chlorophenyl, 4-bromophenyl, 4-nitrophenyl, 4-methylphenyl, 3-methoxy-phenyl, 3-nitrophenyl, 3-fluorophenyl, 3-chlorophenyl, 3-bromophenyl, 3-thiomethoxyphenyl, 3-methylphenyl, 3-trifluoromethylphenyl, 2-hydroxyphenyl, 2-methylphenyl, 2-fluorophenyl, 3,4-dichlorophenyl, 3,4-methylenedioxyphenyl, 3,5-difluorophenyl, 3,5-dichlorophenyl, 2,4-dichlorophenyl and 2,5-difluorophenyl.
7. The pharmaceutical composition according to claim 1 wherein R1 is an alkaryl group.
8. The pharmaceutical composition according to claim 7 wherein the R1 alkaryl group is selected from the group consisting of benzyl, phenylethyl, 3-phenyl-n-propyl and 4-phenyl-n-butyl.
9. The pharmaceutical composition according to claim 1 wherein R1 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkenyl, cycloalkyl and cycloalkenyl groups.
10. The pharmaceutical composition according to claim 9 wherein R1 is alkyl.
11. The pharmaceutical composition according to claim 9 wherein R1 is cycloalkyl.
12. The pharmaceutical composition according to claim 9 wherein R1 is alkenyl.
13. The pharmaceutical composition according to claim 9 wherein R1 is cycloalkenyl.
14. The pharmaceutical composition according to claim 9 wherein the R1 alkyl, cycloalkyl, alkenyl and cycloalkenyl groups are selected from the group consisting of sec-butyl, cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclohexyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohex-1-enyl, —CH2-cyclopropyl, —CH2-cyclobutyl, —CH2-cyclohexyl, —CH2-cyclopentyl, —CH2CH2-cyclopropyl, —CH2CH2-cyclobutyl, —CH2CH2-cyclohexyl, and —CH2CH2-cyclopentyl.
15. The pharmaceutical composition according to claim 1 wherein R1 is selected from the group consisting of heteroaryl and substituted heteroaryl groups.
16. The pharmaceutical composition according to claim 15 wherein the R1 heteroaryl and substituted heteroaryl groups are selected from the group consisting of pyrid-3-yl, pyrid-4-yl, thiophen-2-yl, thiophen-3-yl, benzothiazol-4-yl, 2-phenylbenzoxazol-5-yl, furan-2-yl, benzofuran-2-yl, thionaphthen-2-yl, 2-chlorothiophen-5-yl, 3-methylisoxazol-5-yl, 2-(thiophenyl)thiophen-5-yl, 6-methoxythionaphthen-2-yl, 3-phenyl-1,2,4-thiooxadiazol-5-yl and 2-phenyloxazol-4-yl.
17. The pharmaceutical composition according to claim 1 wherein R2 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl of from 1 to 4 carbon atoms, alkylalkoxy of from 1 to 4 carbon atoms and alkylthioalkoxy of from 1 to 4 carbon atoms.
18. The pharmaceutical composition according to claim 17 wherein R2 is selected from the group consisting of methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, iso-propyl, n-butyl, iso-butyl and —CH2CH2SCH3.
19. The pharmaceutical composition according to claim 3 wherein X′ and X″ are both hydrogen and Z is a covalent bond linking R7 to —CX′X″—.
20. The pharmaceutical composition according to claim 19 wherein R3 is hydrogen and R3′ is selected from the group consisting of 3-hydroxyphenyl, 3-methoxyphenyl, 3-ethoxycarbonylphenyl, n-hexyl, n-octyl, 4-ethoxycarbonylphenyl, 4-methoxycarbonylphenyl, 3-chlorophenyl, 3-cyanophenyl, 3,5-dichlorophenyl, —CH(CH3)φ (R stereoisomer), —CH(CH3)φ (S stereoisomer), phthalid-6-yl, 2-hydroxypyrid-3-yl, 2-(methoxycarbonylmethyl)benzyl, 3-(methoxycarbonyl)benzyl, 2-(2′-methoxycarbonylmethylphenyl)benzyl, and 2-phenylbenzyl.
21. The pharmaceutical composition according to claim 1 wherein the compound of formula I is selected from the group consisting of:
N-(3-hydroxyphenyl)-N′-(phenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide,
N-(3-methoxyphenyl)-N′-(phenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide,
N-(3-ethoxyphenyl)-N′-(phenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide,
N-(4-ethoxycarbonylphenyl)-N′-(phenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide,
N-(n-hexyl)-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide,
N-(n-octyl)-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide,
N-(3-methoxyphenyl)-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide,
N-(4-ethoxycarbonylphenyl)-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide,
N-(3-ethoxycarbonylphenyl)-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide,
N-(3-chlorophenyl)-N′-(3,5 -difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide,
N-(3,5-dichlorophenyl)-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide,
N-(3-cyanophenyl)-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide,
N-(phthalid-6-yl)-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide,
N-[(4-methoxycarbonylphenyl)methyl]-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide,
N-(1-cyano-1-phenylmethyl)-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide,
N-[(R)-1-phenylethyl]-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide,
N-[(S)-1-phenylethyl]-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide,
N-[2-hydroxypyridin-3-yl]-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide,
N-[2-methoxycarbonyl-1-phenylethyl]-N′-(3,5difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide,
N-[α-pyridin-2-yl-benyzl]-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide,
N-[1-(N-phthalamido)pent-2-yl]-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide,
N-[2-(methoxycarbonylmethyl)benzyl]-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide,
N-[3-(methoxycarbonyl)benzyl]-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide,
N-[2-(2′-methoxycarbonylmethylphenyl)benzyl]-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide; and
N-[2-phenylbenzyl]-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide.
22. A compound of formula I:
Figure US06262302-20010717-C00018
wherein R1 is selected from the group consisting of
a) alkyl, alkenyl, alkaryl, alkcycloalkyl, aryl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, heteroaryl and heterocyclic wherein the heteroaryl or heterocyclic group is optionally substituted with 1 to 3 substituents selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, aryl, aryloxy, halo, nitro, thioalkoxy, and thioaryloxy;
(b) a substituted phenyl group of formula II:
Figure US06262302-20010717-C00019
wherein R is alkylene of from 1 to 8 carbon atoms,
m is an integer equal to 0 or 1,
Ra and Ra′ are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, hydroxy, fluoro and methyl;
Rb and Rb′ are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkoxy, aryl, aryloxy, cyano, cycloalkyl, halo, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heterocyclic, nitro, trihalomethyl, thioalkoxy, thioaryloxy, thioheteroaryloxy, and —C(O)R4 where R4 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, aryl, alkoxy and aryloxy; and
Rc is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, aryl, cyano, halo, nitro, and where Rb and Rc are fused to form a methylenedioxy ring with the phenyl ring; and
when Rb and/or Rb′ and/or Rc is fluoro, chloro, bromo and/or nitro, then Ra and/or Ra′ can also be chloro; and
(c) 1- or 2-naphthyl substituted at the 5, 6, 7 and/or 8 positions with 1 to 4 substituents selected from the group consisting of alkyl alkoxy, halo, cyano, nitro, trihalomethyl, and thioalkoxy;
R2 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl of from 1 to 4 carbon atoms, alkylalkoxy of from 1 to 4 carbon atoms, alkylthioalkoxy of from 1 to 4 carbon atoms; and
R3 and R3′ are independently selected from the group consisting of:
(a) hydrogen with the proviso that both R3 and R3′ cannot be hydrogen;
(b) alkyl with the proviso that when R3 is hydrogen, then the R3′ alkyl group has a linear carbon chain length of at least 5 carbon atoms from the nitrogen atom which chain can be optionally substituted with one or more alkyl groups and with the further proviso that when both R3 and R3′ are alkyl then at least one of the alkyl group has a carbon chain length of at least 5 carbon atoms which chain can be optionally substituted with one or more alkyl groups;
(c) —(R7)n (W)p wherein R7 is an alkylene group, W is selected from the group consisting of:
Figure US06262302-20010717-C00020
where R5, R5′, R9 and R9′ are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, hydroxyl, alkyl, an alkyl group having 1 to 3 substituents selected from the group consisting of alkoxy, substituted alkoxy, acyl, acyloxy, acylamino, amino, aminoacyl, aminocarboxy esters, cyano, cycloalkyl, halogen, hydroxyl, carboxyl, carboxyl esters, thio, thioalkoxy, substituted thioalkoxy, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclic, nitro, and mono- and di-(substituted alkyl)amino, mono- and di-arylamino, mono- and di-heterocyclic amino, mono- and di-heteroaryl amino and unsymmetric di-substituted amines having different substituents selected from alkyl, substituted alkyl, aryl, heteroayl, and heterocyclic provided that when the substituent is monoheteroarylamino or unsymmetric di-substituted amines having different substituents selected from alkyl and heteroaryl then the heteroaryl ring is monocyclic, alkoxy, substituted alkoxy, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, aryl, acyl, acylamino, acyloxy, aminoacyl, cyano, cycloalkyl, halogen, carboxyl, carboxyl esters, heteroaryl and heterocyclic; and
R6 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, hydroxyl, alkyl, an alkyl group having 1 to 3 substituents selected from the group consisting of alkoxy, substituted alkoxy, acyl, acyloxy, acylamino, amino, aminoacyl, aminocarboxy esters, cyano, cycloalkyl, halogen, hydroxyl, carboxyl, carboxyl esters, thio, thioalkoxy, substituted thioalkoxy, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclic, nitro, and mono- and di-(substituted alkyl)amino, mono- and di-arylamino, mono- and di-heterocyclic amino, mono- and di-heteroaryl amino and unsymmetric di-substituted amines having different substituents selected from alkyl, substituted alkyl, aryl, heteroayl, and heterocyclic provided that when the substituent is monoheteroarylamino or unsymmetric di-substituted amines having different substituents selected from alkyl and heteroaryl then the heteroaryl ring is monocyclic, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, aryl, acyl, acylamino, acyloxy, alkoxy, substituted alkoxy, aminoacyl, cyano, cycloalkyl, halogen, carboxyl, carboxyl esters, heteroaryl, heterocyclic and where R6 and one of R5 or R5′ are fused to from a heterocyclic ring of from 4 to 10 atoms having from 1 to 3 heteroatoms selected from the group consisting of oxygen, nitrogen and sulfur;
with the proviso that when n is zero, R9 and R9′ are hydrogen;
(ii) heteroaryl; and
(iii) N-heterocyclic with the proviso that when W is N-heterocyclic then n is not zero; and
n is an integer equal to 0 or 1, and
p is an integer equal to 1 to 3 with the proviso that when n is zero then p is equal to 1, and
(d) —CH(φ)CH2C(O)O—Q where Q is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, aryl, heteroaryl and heterocyclic
X′ is hydrogen, hydroxy or fluoro;
X″ is hydrogen, hydroxy or fluoro, or X′ and X″ together form an oxo group,
Z is selected from the group consisting of a bond covalently linking R1 to —CX′X″—, oxygen and sulfur; and
with the proviso that when R1 is phenyl, R2 is methyl, X′ and X″ are hydrogen, Z is a group covalently linking R1 to —CX′X″—, m is zero, R3 is hydrogen, R3′ is —(R7)n (W)p where n is zero and p is one and W is
Figure US06262302-20010717-C00021
then (i) R5, R5′, R9, R9′ and R6 are not all hydrogen and (ii) R5, R5′, R9, R9′ are hydrogen and R6 is methoxy;
with the further proviso that when R1 is 3,5-difluorophenyl, R2 is methyl, X′ and X″ are hydrogen, Z is a group covalently linking R1 to —CX′X″—, m is zero, R3 is hydrogen, R3′ is —(R7)n (W)p where n is one and p is one, R7 is ethylene and W is
Figure US06262302-20010717-C00022
then R5, R5′, R9, R9′ and R6 are not all hydrogen;
with still the further proviso that when R1 is 3,5-difluorophenyl, R2 is methyl, X′ and X″ are hydrogen, Z is a group covalently linking R1 to —CX′X″—, and m is zero, R3 is hydrogen, R3′ is —(R7)n (W)p where n is zero and p is one, W is
Figure US06262302-20010717-C00023
and R5′, R9, R9′ are hydrogen, then R5 and R6 are not fused to form, with the phenyl ring to which they are attached, a phthalimido groups;
with still further proviso that when Z is a group covalently linking R1 to —CX′X″—, X′ and X″ are hydrogen, R2 is alkyl of from 1 to 4 carbon atoms or alkylthioalkoxy of from 1 to 4 carbon atoms, R3 is hydrogen, and R3′ is —(R7)n (W)p where n is zero and p is one and W is
Figure US06262302-20010717-C00024
wherein one of R5, R5′, R6, R9 and R9′ is a carboxyl ester, halogen, or alkoxy, or R5 and R6 form methylenedioxy, then R1 is not alkyl or alkyl substituted with halogen;
with still further proviso that when R1 is alkyl, Z is a group covalently linking R1 to —CX′X″—, X′ and X″ are hydrogen, R3 is hydrogen, and R3′ is —(R7)n (W)p where n is zero and p is one and W is
Figure US06262302-20010717-C00025
then R5, R5′, R9, R9′ and R6 are not all hydrogen; and
with still further proviso that when R1 is phenyl, Z is a group covalently linking R1 to —CX′X″—, X′ and X″ are hydrogen, R3 is hydrogen then R3′ is —(R7)n (W)p where R7 is methylene then W is not Pyridyl or furfural.
23. The compound according to claim 22 wherein R1 is an unsubstituted aryl group.
24. The compound according to claim 22 wherein the unsubstituted R1 aryl group is selected from the group consisting of phenyl, 1-naphthyl and 2-naphthyl.
25. The compound according to claim 22 wherein R1 is a substituted aryl group.
26. The compound according to claim 25 wherein the substituted aryl groups are substituted phenyl groups defined by the following:
(a) monosubstituted phenyls having a single substitution at the 2, 3 or 4 positions wherein each of the particular subsituents is governed by the respective Ra, Rb and Rc groups;
(b) disubstituted phenyls having two substituents at the 2,3-positions, 2,4-positions, 2,5-positions, 2,6-positions, 3,4-positions, 3,5-positions or 3,6-positions wherein each of these substituents is governed by the respective Ra, Ra′, Rb, Rb′ and Rc groups; and
(c) trisubstituted phenyls having three substituents at the 2,3,4-positions, 2,3,5-positions, 2,3,6-positions, 3,4,5-positions and 3,4,6-positions wherein each of these substituents is governed by the respective Ra, Ra′, Rb, Rb′ and Rc groups.
27. The compound according to claim 26 wherein the substituted phenyl groups are selected from the group consisting of 4-fluorophenyl, 4-chlorophenyl, 4-bromophenyl, 4-nitrophenyl, 4-methylphenyl, 3-methoxy-phenyl, 3-nitrophenyl, 3-fluorophenyl, 3-chlorophenyl, 3-bromophenyl, 3-thiomethoxyphenyl, 3-methylphenyl, 3-trifluoromethylphenyl, 2-hydroxy-phenyl, 2-methylphenyl, 2-fluorophenyl, 3,4-dichlorophenyl, 3,4-methylenedioxyphenyl, 3,5-difluorophenyl, 3,5-dichlorophenyl, 2,4-dichlorophenyl and 2,5-difluorophenyl.
28. The compound according to claim 22 wherein R1 is an alkaryl group.
29. The compound according to claim 28 wherein the R1 alkaryl group is selected from the group consisting of benzyl, phenylethyl, 3-phenyl-n-propyl and 4-phenyl-n-butyl.
30. The compound according to claim 22 wherein R1 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkenyl, cycloalkyl and cycloalkenyl groups.
31. The compound according to claim 30 wherein R1 is alkyl.
32. The compound according to claim 30 wherein R1 is cycloalkyl.
33. The compound according to claim 30 wherein R1 is alkenyl.
34. The compound according to claim 30 wherein R1 is cycloalkenyl.
35. The compound according to claim 30 wherein the R1 alkyl, cycloalkyl, alkenyl and cycloalkenyl groups are selected from the group consisting of sec-butyl, cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclohexyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohex-1-enyl, —CH2-cyclopropyl, —CH2-cyclobutyl, —CH2-cyclohexyl, —CH2-cyclopentyl, —CH2CH2-cyclopropyl, —CH2CH2-cyclobutyl, —CH2CH2-cyclohexyl, and —CH2CH2-cyclopentyl.
36. The compound according to claim 22 wherein R1 is selected from the group consisting of heteroaryl and substituted heteroaryl groups.
37. The compound according to claim 36 wherein the R1 heteroaryl and substituted heteroaryl groups are selected from the group consisting of pyrid-3-yl, pyrid-4-yl, thiophen-2-yl, thiophen-3-yl, benzothiazol-4-yl, 2-phenylbenzoxazol-5-yl, furan-2-yl, benzofuran-2-yl, thionaphthen-2-yl, 2-chlorothiophen-5-yl, 3-methylisoxazol-5-yl, 2-(thiophenyl)thiophen-5-yl, 6-methoxythionaphthen-2-yl, 3-phenyl-1,2,4-thiooxadiazol-5-yl and 2-phenyloxazol-4-yl.
38. The compound according to claim 22 wherein R2 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl of from 1 to 4 carbon atoms, alkylalkoxy of from 1 to 4 carbon atoms and alkylthioalkoxy of from 1 to 4 carbon atoms.
39. The compound according to claim 38 wherein R2 is selected from the group consisting of methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, iso-propyl, n-butyl, iso-butyl and —CH2CH2SCH3.
40. The compound according to claim 22 wherein X′ and X″ are both hydrogen and Z is a covalent bond linking R1 to —CX′X″—.
41. The compound according to claim 22 wherein R3 is hydrogen and R3′ is selected from the group consisting of 3-hydroxyphenyl, 3-methoxyphenyl, 3-ethoxycarbonylphenyl, n-hexyl, n-octyl, 4-ethoxycarbonylphenyl, 4-methoxycarbonylphenyl, 3-chlorophenyl, 3-cyanophenyl, 3,5-dichlorophenyl, —CH(CH3)φ (R stereoisomer), —CH(CH3)φ (S stereoisomer), phthalid-6-yl, 2-hydroxypyrid-3-yl, 2-(methoxycarbonylmethyl)benzyl, 3-(methoxycarbonyl)benzyl, 2-(2′-methoxycarbonylmethylphenyl)benzyl, and 2-phenylbenzyl.
42. The compound according to claim 1 wherein the compound of formula I is selected from the group consisting of:
N-(3-hydroxyphenyl)-N′-(phenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide,
N-(3-methoxyphenyl)-N′-(phenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide,
N-(3-ethoxyphenyl)-N′-(phenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide,
N-(4-ethoxycarbonylphenyl)-N′-(phenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide,
N-(n-hexyl)-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide,
N-(n-octyl)-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide,
N-(3-methoxyphenyl)-N′- (3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L -alaninamide,
N-(4-ethoxycarbonylphenyl)-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide,
N-(3-ethoxycarbonylphenyl)-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide,
N-(3-chlorophenyl)-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide,
N-(3,5-dichlorophenyl)-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide,
N-(3-cyanophenyl)-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide,
N-(phthalid-6-yl)-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide,
N-[(4-methoxycarbonylphenyl)methyl]-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide,
N-(1-cyano-1-phenylmethyl)-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide,
N-[(R)-1-phenylethyl]-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide,
N-[(S)-1-phenylethyl]-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide,
N-[2-hydroxypyridin-3-yl]-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide,
N-[2-methoxycarbonyl-1-phenylethyl]-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide,
N-[α-pyridin-2-yl-benyzl]-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide,
N-[1-(N-phthlamido)pent-2-yl]-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide,
N-[2-(methoxycarbonylmethyl)benzyl]-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide,
N-[3-(methoxycarbonyl)benzyl]-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide,
N-[2-(2′-methoxycarbonylmethylphenyl)benzyl]-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide; and
N-[2-phenylbenzyl]-N′-(3,5-difluorophenylacetyl)-L-alaninamide.
43. A pharmaceutical composition comprising a pharmaceutically inert carrier and a pharmaceutically effective amount of a compound of formula I:
Figure US06262302-20010717-C00026
wherein R1 is selected from the group consisting of
a) alkenyl, alkaryl, alkcycloalkyl, aryl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, heteroaryl and heterocyclic wherein the heteroaryl or heterocyclic group is optionally substituted with 1 to 3 substituents selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, aryloxy, halo, nitro, thioalkoxy, thioaryloxy and aryl substituted with 1-3 substituents selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, acyl, acyloxy, alkyl, alkoxy, alkenyl, alkynyl, amino, aminoacyl, aryl, aryoxy, carboxyl, carboxyl esters, amino carboxyl esters, cyano, halo, nitro, heteroaryl, herterocyclic, thioalkoxy, trihalomethyl;
(b) a substituted phenyl group of formula II:
Figure US06262302-20010717-C00027
wherein R is alkylene of from 1 to 8 carbon atoms,
m is an integer equal to 0 or 1,
Ra and Ra′ are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, hydroxy, fluoro and methyl;
Rb and Rb′ are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkoxy, aryl, aryloxy, cyano, cycloalkyl, halo, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heterocyclic, nitro, trihalomethyl, thioalkoxy, thioaryloxy, thioheteroaryloxy, and —C(O)R4 where R4 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, aryl, alkoxy and aryloxy; and
Rc is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, aryl, cyano, halo, nitro, and where Rb and Rc are fused to form a methylenedioxy ring with the phenyl ring; and
when Rb and/or Rb′ and/or Rc is fluoro, chloro, bromo and/or nitro, then Ra and/or Ra′ can also be chloro; and
(c) 1- or 2-naphthyl substituted at the 5, 6, 7 and/or 8 positions with 1 to 4 substituents selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halo, cyano, nitro, trihalomethyl, and thioalkoxy;
R2 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl of from 1 to 4 carbon atoms, alkylalkoxy of from 1 to 4 carbon atoms, alkylthioalkoxy of from 1 to 4 carbon atoms; and
R3 and R3′ are independently selected from the group consisting of:
(a) hydrogen with the proviso that both R3 and R3′ cannot be hydrogen;
(b) alkyl with the proviso that when R3 is hydrogen, then the R3′ alkyl group has a linear carbon chain length of at least 5 carbon atoms from the nitrogen atom which chain can be optionally substituted with one or more alkyl groups and with the further proviso that when both R3 and R3′ are alkyl then at least one of the alkyl group has a carbon chain length of at least 5 carbon atoms which chain can be optionally substituted with one or more alkyl groups;
(c) —(R7)n (W)p wherein R7 is an alkylene group, W is selected from the group consisting of:
Figure US06262302-20010717-C00028
where R5, R5′, R9 and R9′ are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, hydroxyl, alkyl, an alkyl group having 1 to 3 substituents selected from the group consisting of alkoxy, substituted alkoxy, acyl, acyloxy, acylamino, amino, aminoacyl, aminocarboxy esters, cyano, cycloalkyl, halogen, hydroxyl, carboxyl, carboxyl esters, thio, thioalkoxy, substituted thioalkoxy, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclic, nitro, and mono- and di-(substituted alkyl)amino, mono- and di-arylamino, mono- and di-heterocyclic amino, mono- and di-heteroaryl amino and unsymmetric di-substituted amines having different substituents selected from alkyl, substituted alkyl, aryl, heteroayl, and heterocyclic provided that when the substituent is monoheteroarylamino or unsymmetric di-substituted amines having different substituents selected from alkyl and heteroaryl then the heteroaryl ring is monocyclic, alkoxy, substituted alkoxy, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, aryl, acyl, acylamino, acyloxy, aminoacyl, cyano, cycloalkyl,halogen, carboxyl, carboxyl esters, heteroaryl and heterocyclic; and
R6 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, hydroxyl, alkyl, an alkyl group having 1 to 3 substituents selected from the group consisting of alkoxy, substituted alkoxy, acyl, acyloxy, acylamino, amino, aminoacyl, aminocarboxy esters, cyano, cycloalkyl, halogen, hydroxyl, carboxyl, carboxyl esters, thio, thioalkoxy, substituted thioalkoxy, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclic, nitro, and mono- and di-(substituted alkyl)amino, mono- and di-arylamino, mono- and di-heterocyclic amino, mono- and di-heteroaryl amino and unsymmetric di-substituted amines having different substituents selected from alkyl, substituted alkyl, aryl, heteroayl, and heterocyclic provided that when the substituent is monoheteroarylamino or unsymmetric di-substituted amines having different substituents selected from alkyl and heteroaryl then the heteroaryl ring is monocyclic, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, aryl, acyl, acylamino, acyloxy, alkoxy, substituted alkoxy, aminoacyl, cyano, cycloalkyl, halogen, carboxyl, carboxyl esters, heteroaryl, heterocyclic and where R6 and one of R5 or R5′ are fused to from a heterocyclic ring of from 4 to 10 atoms having from 1 to 3 heteroatoms selected from the group consisting of oxygen, nitrogen and sulfur;
with the proviso that when n is zero, R9 and R9′ are hydrogen;
(ii) heteroaryl; and
(iii) N-heterocyclic with the proviso that when W is N-heterocyclic then n is not zero; and
n is an integer equal to 0 or 1, and
p is an integer equal to 1 to 3 with the proviso that when n is zero then p is equal to 1, and
(d) —CH(φ)CH2C(O)O—Q where Q is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, aryl, heteroaryl and heterocyclic
X′ is hydrogen, hydroxy or fluoro;
X″ is hydrogen, hydroxy or fluoro, or X′ and X″ together form an oxo group,
Z is selected from the group consisting of a bond covalently linking R1 to —CX′X″—, oxygen and sulfur; and
with the proviso that when R1 is phenyl, R2 is methyl, X′ and X″ are hydrogen, Z is a group covalently linking R1 to —CX′X″—, m is zero, R3 is hydrogen, R3′ is —(R7)n (W)p where n is zero and p is one and W is
Figure US06262302-20010717-C00029
then (i) R5, R5′, R9, R9′ and R6 are not all hydrogen and (ii) R5, R5′, R9, R9′ are hydrogen and R6 is methoxy;
with the further proviso that when R1 is 3,5-difluorophenyl, R2 is methyl, X′ and X″ are hydrogen, Z is a group covalently linking R1 to —CX′X″—, m is zero, R3 is hydrogen, R3′ is —(R7)n(W)p where n is one and p is one, R7 is ethylene and W is
Figure US06262302-20010717-C00030
then R5, R5′,R9, R9′ and R6 are not all hydrogen; and
with still the further proviso that when R1 is 3,5-difluorophenyl, R2 is methyl, X′ and X″ are hydrogen, Z is a group covalently linking R1 to —CX′X″—, and m is zero, R3 is hydrogen, R3′ is —(R7)n (W)p where n is zero and p is one, W is
Figure US06262302-20010717-C00031
and R5′, R9, R9′ are hydrogen, then R5 and R6 are not fused to form, with the phenyl ring to which they are attached, a phthalimido group.
44. A compound of formula I:
Figure US06262302-20010717-C00032
wherein R1 is selected from the group consisting of
a) alkenyl, alkaryl, alkcycloalkyl, aryl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, heteroaryl and heterocyclic wherein the heteroaryl or heterocyclic group is optionally substituted with 1 to 3 substituents selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, aryloxy, halo, nitro, thioalkoxy, thioaryloxy and aryl substituted with 1-3 substituents selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, acyl, acyloxy, alkyl, alkoxy, alkenyl, alkynyl, amino, amimoacyl, aryl, aryoxy, carboxyl, carboxyl esters, amino carboxyl esters, cyano, halo, nitro, heteroaryl, herterocyclic, thioalkoxy, trihalomethyl;
(b) a substituted phenyl group of formula II:
Figure US06262302-20010717-C00033
wherein R is alkylene of from 1 to 8 carbon atoms,
m is an integer equal to 0 or 1,
Ra and Ra′ are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, hydroxy, fluoro and methyl;
Rb and Rb′ are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkoxy, aryl, aryloxy, cyano, cycloalkyl, halo, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heterocyclic, nitro, trihalomethyl, thioalkoxy, thioaryloxy, thioheteroaryloxy, and —C(O)R4 where R4 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, aryl, alkoxy and aryloxy; and
Rc is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, aryl, cyano, halo, nitro, and where Rb and Rc are fused to form a methylenedioxy ring with the phenyl ring; and
when Rb and/or Rb′ and/or Rc is fluoro, chloro, bromo and/or nitro, then Ra and/or Ra′ can also be chloro; and
(c) 1- or 2-naphthyl substituted at the 5, 6, 7 and/or 8 positions with 1 to 4 substituents selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halo, cyano, nitro, trihalomethyl, and thioalkoxy;
R2 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl of from 1 to 4 carbon atoms, alkylalkoxy of from 1 to 4 carbon atoms, alkylthioalkoxy of from 1 to 4 carbon atoms; and
R3 and R3′ are independently selected from the group consisting of:
(a) hydrogen with the proviso that both R3 and R3′ cannot be hydrogen;
(b) alkyl with the proviso that when R3 is hydrogen, then the R3′ alkyl group has a linear carbon chain length of at least 5 carbon atoms from the nitrogen atom which chain can be optionally substituted with one or more alkyl groups and with the further proviso that when both R3 and R3′ are alkyl then at least one of the alkyl group has a carbon chain length of at least 5 carbon atoms which chain can be optionally substituted with one or more alkyl groups;
(c) —(R7)n (W)p wherein R7 is an alkylene group, W is selected from the group consisting of:
Figure US06262302-20010717-C00034
where R5, R5′, R9 and R9′ are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, hydroxyl, alkyl, an alkyl group having 1 to 3 substituents selected from the group consisting of alkoxy, substituted alkoxy, acyl, acyloxy, acylamino, amino, aminoacyl, aminocarboxy esters, cyano, cycloalkyl, halogen, hydroxyl, carboxyl, carboxyl esters, thio, thioalkoxy, substituted thioalkoxy, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclic, nitro, and mono- and di-(substituted alkyl)amino, mono- and di-arylamino, mono- and di-heterocyclic amino, mono- and di-heteroaryl amino and unsymmetric di-substituted amines having different substituents selected from alkyl, substituted alkyl, aryl, heteroayl, and heterocyclic provided that when the substituent is monoheteroarylamino or unsymmetric di-substituted amines having different substituents selected from alkyl and heteroaryl then the heteroaryl ring is monocyclic, alkoxy, substituted alkoxy, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, aryl, acyl, acylamino, acyloxy, aminoacyl, cyano, cycloalkyl,halogen, carboxyl, carboxyl esters, heteroaryl and heterocyclic; and
R6 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, hydroxyl, alkyl, an alkyl group having 1 to 3 substituents selected from the group consisting of alkoxy, substituted alkoxy, acyl, acyloxy, acylamino, amino, aminoacyl, aminocarboxy esters, cyano, cycloalkyl, halogen, hydroxyl, carboxyl, carboxyl esters, thio, thioalkoxy, substituted thioalkoxy, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclic, nitro, and mono- and di-(substituted alkyl)amino, mono- and di-arylamino, mono- and di-heterocyclic amino, mono- and di-heteroaryl amino and unsymmetric di-substituted amines having different substituents selected from alkyl, substituted alkyl, aryl, heteroayl, and heterocyclic provided that when the substituent is monoheteroarylamino or unsymmetric di-substituted amines having different substituents selected from alkyl and heteroaryl then the heteroaryl ring is monocyclic, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, aryl, acyl, acylamino, acyloxy, alkoxy, substituted alkoxy, aminoacyl, cyano, cycloalkyl, halogen, carboxyl, carboxyl esters, heteroaryl, heterocyclic and where R6 and one of R5 or R5′ are fused to from a heterocyclic ring of from 4 to 10 atoms having from 1 to 3 heteroatoms selected from the group consisting of oxygen, nitrogen and sulfur;
with the proviso that when n is zero, R9 and R9′ are hydrogen;
(ii) heteroaryl; and
(iii) N-heterocyclic with the proviso that when W is N-heterocyclic then n is not zero; and
n is an integer equal to 0 or 1, and
p is an integer equal to 1 to 3 with the proviso that when n is zero then p is equal to 1, and
(d) —CH(φ)CH2C(O)O—Q where Q is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, aryl, heteroaryl and heterocyclic
X′ is hydrogen, hydroxy or fluoro;
X″ is hydrogen, hydroxy or fluoro, or X′ and X″ together form an oxo group,
Z is selected from the group consisting of a bond covalently linking R1 to —CX′X″—, oxygen and sulfur; and
with the proviso that when R1 is phenyl, R2 is methyl, X′ and X″ are hydrogen, Z is a group covalently linking R1 to —CX′X″—, m is zero, R3 is hydrogen, R3′ is —(R7)n (W)p where n is zero and p is one and W is
Figure US06262302-20010717-C00035
then (i) R5, R5′, R9, R9′ and R6 are not all hydrogen and (ii) R5, R5′, R9, R9′ are hydrogen and R6 is methoxy;
with the further proviso that when R1 is 3,5-difluorophenyl, R2 is methyl, X′ and X″ are hydrogen, Z is a group covalently linking R1 to —CX′X″—, m is zero, R3 is hydrogen, R3′ is —(R7)n(W)p where n is one and p is one, R7 is ethylene and W is
Figure US06262302-20010717-C00036
then R5, R5′, R9, R9′ and R6 are not all hydrogen; and
with still the further proviso that when R1 is 3,5-difluorophenyl, R2 is methyl, X′ and X″ are hydrogen, Z is a group covalently linking R1 to —CX′X″—, and m is zero, R3 is hydrogen, R3′ is —(R7)n (W)p where n is zero and p is one, W is
Figure US06262302-20010717-C00037
and R5′, R9, R9′ are hydrogen, then R5 and R6 are not fused to form, with the phenyl ring to which they are attached, a phthalimido group.
US09/398,211 1996-11-22 1999-09-17 N-(aryl/heteroaryl/alkylacetyl) amino acid amides, pharmaceutical compositions comprising same, and methods for inhibiting β-amyloid peptide release and/or its synthesis by use of such compounds Expired - Fee Related US6262302B1 (en)

Priority Applications (1)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US09/398,211 US6262302B1 (en) 1996-11-22 1999-09-17 N-(aryl/heteroaryl/alkylacetyl) amino acid amides, pharmaceutical compositions comprising same, and methods for inhibiting β-amyloid peptide release and/or its synthesis by use of such compounds

Applications Claiming Priority (4)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US9855196P 1996-11-22 1996-11-22
US11367197P 1997-02-28 1997-02-28
US08/976,295 US6153652A (en) 1996-11-22 1997-11-21 N-(aryl/heteroaryl/alkylacetyl) amino acid amides, pharmaceutical compositions comprising same, and methods for inhibiting β-amyloid peptide release and/or its synthesis by use of such compounds
US09/398,211 US6262302B1 (en) 1996-11-22 1999-09-17 N-(aryl/heteroaryl/alkylacetyl) amino acid amides, pharmaceutical compositions comprising same, and methods for inhibiting β-amyloid peptide release and/or its synthesis by use of such compounds

Related Parent Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US08/976,295 Continuation US6153652A (en) 1996-11-22 1997-11-21 N-(aryl/heteroaryl/alkylacetyl) amino acid amides, pharmaceutical compositions comprising same, and methods for inhibiting β-amyloid peptide release and/or its synthesis by use of such compounds

Publications (1)

Publication Number Publication Date
US6262302B1 true US6262302B1 (en) 2001-07-17

Family

ID=27378625

Family Applications (2)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US08/976,295 Expired - Lifetime US6153652A (en) 1996-11-22 1997-11-21 N-(aryl/heteroaryl/alkylacetyl) amino acid amides, pharmaceutical compositions comprising same, and methods for inhibiting β-amyloid peptide release and/or its synthesis by use of such compounds
US09/398,211 Expired - Fee Related US6262302B1 (en) 1996-11-22 1999-09-17 N-(aryl/heteroaryl/alkylacetyl) amino acid amides, pharmaceutical compositions comprising same, and methods for inhibiting β-amyloid peptide release and/or its synthesis by use of such compounds

Family Applications Before (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US08/976,295 Expired - Lifetime US6153652A (en) 1996-11-22 1997-11-21 N-(aryl/heteroaryl/alkylacetyl) amino acid amides, pharmaceutical compositions comprising same, and methods for inhibiting β-amyloid peptide release and/or its synthesis by use of such compounds

Country Status (1)

Country Link
US (2) US6153652A (en)

Cited By (3)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US6849650B2 (en) * 1998-02-27 2005-02-01 Athena Neurosciences, Inc. Heterocyclic compounds, pharmaceutical compositions comprising same, and methods for inhibiting β-amyloid peptide release and/or its synthesis by use of such compounds
US6964957B2 (en) 2000-08-18 2005-11-15 Agouron Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Fused pyrazole compounds, pharmaceutical compositions, and methods for modulating or inhibiting ERAB or HADH2 activity
US20060014704A1 (en) * 2004-07-16 2006-01-19 Landry Donald W Compounds and their preparation for the treatment of Alzheimer's disease by inhibiting beta-amyloid peptide production

Families Citing this family (12)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US6992081B2 (en) 2000-03-23 2006-01-31 Elan Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Compounds to treat Alzheimer's disease
ES2275675T3 (en) * 2000-03-23 2007-06-16 Elan Pharmaceuticals, Inc. COMPOUNDS AND METHODS TO TREAT ALZHEIMER'S DISEASE.
PE20020276A1 (en) 2000-06-30 2002-04-06 Elan Pharm Inc SUBSTITUTE AMINE COMPOUNDS AS ß-SECRETASE INHIBITORS FOR THE TREATMENT OF ALZHEIMER
CA2410972A1 (en) 2000-06-30 2002-01-10 Elan Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Compounds to treat alzheimer's disease
US6846813B2 (en) * 2000-06-30 2005-01-25 Pharmacia & Upjohn Company Compounds to treat alzheimer's disease
US20030096864A1 (en) * 2000-06-30 2003-05-22 Fang Lawrence Y. Compounds to treat alzheimer's disease
US20070213407A1 (en) * 2001-06-29 2007-09-13 Elan Pharmaceuticals And Pharmacia & Upjohn Company Llc Compounds to treat Alzheimer's disease
WO2003094854A2 (en) * 2002-05-07 2003-11-20 Elan Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Succinoyl aminopyrazoles and related compounds
CA2528496C (en) * 2003-06-05 2011-04-12 Elan Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Acylated amino acid amidyl pyrazoles and related compounds
US20050182044A1 (en) * 2004-02-17 2005-08-18 Bruinsma Gosse B. Combinatorial therapy with an acetylcholinesterase inhibitor and (3aR)-1,3a,8-trimethyl-1,2,3,3a,8,8a-hexahydropyrrolo[2,3,-b]indol-5-yl phenylcarbamate
CA2508585A1 (en) * 2004-06-01 2005-12-01 Axonyx, Inc. Transdermal delivery system for treatment of cognitive disorders
WO2005123068A2 (en) * 2004-06-08 2005-12-29 Axonyx, Inc. Methods of dealying alzheimer’s disease progression using a beta-amyloid precursor protein inhibitor and a hmg coa reductase inhibitor

Citations (8)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
DE1927692A1 (en) 1968-06-04 1969-12-11 Beecham Group Ltd Amide derivatives and processes for their preparation
US3876683A (en) 1972-05-05 1975-04-08 Science Union & Cie (n-carboxymethyl)biphenyl acetamides
CA2129689A1 (en) 1993-08-09 1995-02-10 Harry F. Dovey Identification and use of protease inhibitors
WO1995009838A1 (en) 1993-10-01 1995-04-13 Merrell Pharmaceuticals Inc. INHIBITORS OF β-AMYLOID PROTEIN PRODUCTION
US5478857A (en) 1993-12-23 1995-12-26 Eli Lilly And Company Use of PLA2 inhibitors as treatment for alzheimer's disease
WO1996039194A1 (en) 1995-06-06 1996-12-12 Athena Neurosciences, Inc. Novel cathepsin and methods and compositions for inhibition thereof
EP0778266A1 (en) 1995-12-05 1997-06-11 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company 5-Amino-6-cyclohexyl-4-hydroxy-hexanamide derivatives as inhibitors of beta-amyloid protein production
US5952346A (en) 1996-10-14 1999-09-14 Hoechst Marion Roussel Deutschland Gmbh Use of non-peptide bradykinin antagonists for the treatment or prevention of Alzheimer's disease

Patent Citations (9)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
DE1927692A1 (en) 1968-06-04 1969-12-11 Beecham Group Ltd Amide derivatives and processes for their preparation
US3657341A (en) 1968-06-04 1972-04-18 Beecham Group Ltd Acetyl glycine amides
US3876683A (en) 1972-05-05 1975-04-08 Science Union & Cie (n-carboxymethyl)biphenyl acetamides
CA2129689A1 (en) 1993-08-09 1995-02-10 Harry F. Dovey Identification and use of protease inhibitors
WO1995009838A1 (en) 1993-10-01 1995-04-13 Merrell Pharmaceuticals Inc. INHIBITORS OF β-AMYLOID PROTEIN PRODUCTION
US5478857A (en) 1993-12-23 1995-12-26 Eli Lilly And Company Use of PLA2 inhibitors as treatment for alzheimer's disease
WO1996039194A1 (en) 1995-06-06 1996-12-12 Athena Neurosciences, Inc. Novel cathepsin and methods and compositions for inhibition thereof
EP0778266A1 (en) 1995-12-05 1997-06-11 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company 5-Amino-6-cyclohexyl-4-hydroxy-hexanamide derivatives as inhibitors of beta-amyloid protein production
US5952346A (en) 1996-10-14 1999-09-14 Hoechst Marion Roussel Deutschland Gmbh Use of non-peptide bradykinin antagonists for the treatment or prevention of Alzheimer's disease

Non-Patent Citations (12)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Title
Chemical Abstracts, "V. Decomposition of aqueous Solution of Benzylpenicillin by aniline and Ring Substitutes anilines" vol., 54, No. 11, Jun. 10, 1960.
Cordell. B-Amyloid formation as a Potential Therapeutic Target for Alzheimer's Disease. Annu. Rev. Pharmacol. Toxicol. 34: 69-89 (1994).
Database CAPLUS on STN, Acc. No. 1995:810448, Dovey et al. "Aspartyl Proteinase Inhibitor Preparation, Assay and Use for Treatment of Alzheimer's Disease.' CA 2129689 (abstract).
Database Caplus on STN, Acc. No. 1995:837456, Cordell et al. "Preparation of Peptide Analogs as Inibitors of beta-amyloid protein production.' WO 9509838 (abstract).
Doherty, et al., The Resolution of Amino Acids by Asymmetric Enzymatic Synthesis, J. Biol. Chem., 189: 447-454 (1951).
Hlavacek, et al., Amino Acid Derivatives with Acyl and Chloroacyl protecting groups Synthesis and Insect Juvenile Hormaone Activity, Collection of Czechoslovak Chemical Communications, 41: 1257-1264 (1976).
Ogawa, et al., A New Method for Preparing D-penicillamine. Reaction of Benylpenicilloic acid alpha-amids with arylamines, Chem. Pharm. Bull. 36(6): 1957-1962 (1988).
Ogawa, et al., A New Method for Preparing D-penicillamine. Reaction of Benylpenicilloic acid α-amids with arylamines, Chem. Pharm. Bull. 36(6): 1957-1962 (1988).
Pazhanisamy et al., "Beta-catalyzed aminolysis of depsipeptides: Peptide Inhibition and a new kinetic mechanism.' Biochemistry, 1989, 28, p. 6875-6882, 1989. *
Pazhanisamy, et al. beta-Lactamase-catalyzed aminolysis of Depsipeptides: Peptide Inhibition and a New Kinetic Mechanism, Biochemistry, 28(17): 6875-6882 (1989).
Pazhanisamy, et al. β-Lactamase-catalyzed aminolysis of Depsipeptides: Peptide Inhibition and a New Kinetic Mechanism, Biochemistry, 28(17): 6875-6882 (1989).
Smith, et al. B-APP Processing as a Therapeutic Target for Alzheimer's Disease. Current Pharmaceutical Design, 3, 439-445 (1997).

Cited By (4)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US6849650B2 (en) * 1998-02-27 2005-02-01 Athena Neurosciences, Inc. Heterocyclic compounds, pharmaceutical compositions comprising same, and methods for inhibiting β-amyloid peptide release and/or its synthesis by use of such compounds
US6964957B2 (en) 2000-08-18 2005-11-15 Agouron Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Fused pyrazole compounds, pharmaceutical compositions, and methods for modulating or inhibiting ERAB or HADH2 activity
US20060014704A1 (en) * 2004-07-16 2006-01-19 Landry Donald W Compounds and their preparation for the treatment of Alzheimer's disease by inhibiting beta-amyloid peptide production
US20060014729A1 (en) * 2004-07-16 2006-01-19 Landry Donald W Compounds and their preparation for the treatment of Alzheimer's disease by inhibiting beta-amyloid peptide production

Also Published As

Publication number Publication date
US6153652A (en) 2000-11-28

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
EP0946499B1 (en) N-(aryl/heteroaryl/alkylacetyl) amino acid amides, pharmaceutical compositions comprising same, and methods for inhibiting beta-amyloid peptide release and/or its synthesis by use of such compounds
EP0951464B1 (en) N-(aryl/heteroarylacetyl) amino acid esters, pharmaceutical compositions comprising same, and methods for inhibiting beta-amyloid peptide release and/or its synthesis by use of such compounds
US6861558B2 (en) Methods and compounds for inhibiting β-amyloid peptide release and/or its synthesis
WO1998022430A9 (en) N-(ARYL/HETEROARYLACETYL) AMINO ACID ESTERS, PHARMACEUTICAL COMPOSITIONS COMPRISING SAME, AND METHODS FOR INHIBITING b-AMYLOID PEPTIDE RELEASE AND/OR ITS SYNTHESIS BY USE OF SUCH COMPOUNDS
US6476263B1 (en) Compounds for inhibiting β-amyloid peptide release and/or its synthesis
US6262302B1 (en) N-(aryl/heteroaryl/alkylacetyl) amino acid amides, pharmaceutical compositions comprising same, and methods for inhibiting β-amyloid peptide release and/or its synthesis by use of such compounds
WO1998022494A9 (en) METHODS AND COMPOUNDS FOR INHIBITING β-AMYLOID PEPTIDE RELEASE AND/OR SYNTHESIS
NZ334690A (en) Substituted amino acid ester derivatives useful for inhibiting beta-amyloid peptide release and/or synthesis
US6495693B2 (en) N-(aryl/heteroaryl) amino acid derivatives, pharmaceutical compositions comprising same, and methods for inhibiting β-amyloid peptide release and/or its synthesis by use of such compounds
US6207710B1 (en) Compounds for inhibiting β-amyloid peptide release and/or its synthesis
US6313152B1 (en) N(aryl/heteroarylacetyl) amino acid esters, pharmaceutical compositions comprising same, and methods for inhibiting β-amyloid peptide release and/or its synthesis by use of such compounds
US6767918B2 (en) N-(aryl/heteroarylacetyl) amino acid esters, pharmaceutical compositions comprising same, and methods for inhibiting β-amyloid peptide release and/or its synthesis by use of such compounds
WO2001034639A2 (en) β-AMINOACID COMPOUNDS USEFUL FOR INHIBITING β-AMYLOID PEPTIDE RELEASE AND/OR ITS SYNTHESIS
MXPA99004394A (en) N-(ARYL/HETEROARYL/ALKYLACETYL) AMINO ACID AMIDES, PHARMACEUTICAL COMPOSITIONS COMPRISING SAME, AND METHODS FOR INHIBITING&bgr;-AMYLOID PEPTIDE RELEASE AND/OR ITS SYNTHESIS BY USE OF SUCH COMPOUNDS
CZ9901630A3 (en) Amines of N-(aryl/heteroaryl/alkylacetyl)amino acids, pharmaceutical compositions in which they are comprised and inhibition methods of releasing beta-amyloid peptide and/or synthesis thereof by making use of such compounds
MXPA99004302A (en) N-(ARYL/HETEROARYLACETYL) AMINO ACID ESTERS, PHARMACEUTICAL COMPOSITIONS COMPRISING SAME, AND METHODS FOR INHIBITING b
CZ124499A3 (en) Esters of N-(aryl/heteroarylacetyl)amino acids, pharmaceutical compositions in which they are comprised and inhibition processes of beta-amyloid peptide release and/or synthesis thereof by making use of such compounds

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
CC Certificate of correction
FPAY Fee payment

Year of fee payment: 4

REMI Maintenance fee reminder mailed
LAPS Lapse for failure to pay maintenance fees
STCH Information on status: patent discontinuation

Free format text: PATENT EXPIRED DUE TO NONPAYMENT OF MAINTENANCE FEES UNDER 37 CFR 1.362

FP Lapsed due to failure to pay maintenance fee

Effective date: 20090717